blob: d3ff22341bede282e4582901fe37ae51a4825c04 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7d1b48f2016-05-10 15:36:58 +02007 2016/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200581 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200582 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200583 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - tune.buffers.limit
585 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200586 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200587 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100588 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100589 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200590 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100591 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100592 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100593 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100594 - tune.lua.session-timeout
595 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200596 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100597 - tune.maxaccept
598 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200600 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200601 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100602 - tune.rcvbuf.client
603 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100604 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100605 - tune.sndbuf.client
606 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100607 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100608 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200609 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100610 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200611 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200612 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200613 - tune.vars.global-max-size
614 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
615 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
616 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100617 - tune.zlib.memlevel
618 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 * Debugging
621 - debug
622 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626------------------------------------
627
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628ca-base <dir>
629 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200630 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
631 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633chroot <jail dir>
634 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
635 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
636 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
637 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
638 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
639 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100641cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
642 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
643 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
644 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100645 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
646 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
647 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
648 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
649 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
650 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
651 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
652 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
653 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
654 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200656crt-base <dir>
657 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
658 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
659 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661daemon
662 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
663 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
664 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
665
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200666deviceatlas-json-file <path>
667 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
668 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
669
670deviceatlas-log-level <value>
671 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
672 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
673
674deviceatlas-separator <char>
675 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
676 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
677
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100678deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200679 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
680 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
681 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900683external-check
684 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
685 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
686 See "option external-check".
687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688gid <number>
689 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
690 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
691 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100692 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
693 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696group <group name>
697 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
698 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200700log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
702 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 configured with "log global".
704
705 <address> can be one of:
706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100707 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100711 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
712 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
713 port).
714
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
716 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
717 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
718 writeable).
719
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
721 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100722
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200723 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
724 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
725 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
726 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
727 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
728 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
729 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
730 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
731 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
732 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
733 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
736 one of the following :
737
738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
740
741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745
746 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
747 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
748 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
749
750 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200751 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
752 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
753 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
754 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
755 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100760log-send-hostname [<string>]
761 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
762 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
763 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
764 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
765 the logs.
766
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767log-tag <string>
768 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
769 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
770 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100771 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000772
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100773lua-load <file>
774 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
775 used multiple times.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777nbproc <number>
778 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
779 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
780 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
781 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
782 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
783
784pidfile <pidfile>
785 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
786 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
787 starting the process. See also "daemon".
788
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100789presetenv <name> <value>
790 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
791 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
792 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
793 and "unsetenv".
794
795resetenv [<name> ...]
796 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
797 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
798 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
799 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
800 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
801 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
802 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
803 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
804
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100805stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200806 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
807 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
808 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
809 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
810 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
811 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200813 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
814 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200816server-state-base <directory>
817 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200818 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
819 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200820
821server-state-file <file>
822 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
823 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
824 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
825 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
826 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
827 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
828 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
829 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200830 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
831 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200832
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100833setenv <name> <value>
834 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
835 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
836 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
837 and "unsetenv".
838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100843 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
844 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
845 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
846 "bind" keyword for more information.
847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100848ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
851 keyword to see available options.
852
853 Example:
854 global
855 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
856
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
859 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300860 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100861 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
862 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
863 information.
864
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100865ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
867 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
868 keyword to see available options.
869
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200870ssl-dh-param-file <file>
871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
872 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
873 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
874 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
875 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200876 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
877 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
878 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
879 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
881 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
882 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
883
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100884ssl-server-verify [none|required]
885 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
886 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
887 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
888
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200889stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
890 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
891 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
892 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200893 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
894 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
897 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
898 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200899
900stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
901 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
902 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100903 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200904
905stats maxconn <connections>
906 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
907 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909uid <number>
910 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
911 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
912 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
913 one. See also "gid" and "user".
914
915ulimit-n <number>
916 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
917 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
918 option.
919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100920unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
921 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
922
923 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
924 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
925 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
926 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
927 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
928 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
929 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
930 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
931 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
932 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
933
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100934unsetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
936 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
937 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
938 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
939 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
940 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
941 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943user <user name>
944 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
945 See also "uid" and "group".
946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200947node <name>
948 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
949
950 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
951 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
952 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
953 traffic.
954
955description <text>
956 Add a text that describes the instance.
957
958 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
959 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
960 "<" and ">" characters.
961
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096251degrees-data-file <file path>
963 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
964 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
965
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200966 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100967 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
968
96951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
970 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
971 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
972 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
973
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200974 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100975 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
976
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100978 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
979 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
98451degrees-cache-size <number>
985 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
986 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
987 By default, this cache is disabled.
988
989 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100990 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994-----------------------
995
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200996max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
997 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
998 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
999 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1000 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1001 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1002 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1003 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1004 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006maxconn <number>
1007 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1008 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1009 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001010 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1011 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1012 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1013 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001014 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1015 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1016 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1017 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1018 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001020maxconnrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001030maxcomprate <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001032 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1034 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1035 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1036 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1037 default value.
1038
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001039maxcompcpuusage <number>
1040 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1041 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1042 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1043 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1044 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1045 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1046 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1047 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1048
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001049maxpipes <number>
1050 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1051 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1052 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1053 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1054 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1055 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1056
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057maxsessrate <number>
1058 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1065 fairness.
1066
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067maxsslconn <number>
1068 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1069 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1070 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1071 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1072 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1073 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1074 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001075 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1076 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1077 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1078 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1079 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1080 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1081 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001082
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001083maxsslrate <number>
1084 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1085 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1086 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1087 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1088 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1089 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1090 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1091 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1092 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1093 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1094
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001095maxzlibmem <number>
1096 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1097 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1098 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001099 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1100 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1101 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103noepoll
1104 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1105 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001106 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107
1108nokqueue
1109 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1110 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1111 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1112
1113nopoll
1114 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1115 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001117 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119nosplice
1120 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1121 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1122 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001124 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1125 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1126 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1127 "option splice-response".
1128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001129nogetaddrinfo
1130 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1131 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1132
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001133spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001134 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1135 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1136 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1137 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1138 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1139 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001141tune.buffers.limit <number>
1142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1147 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001164tune.bufsize <number>
1165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001173 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1174 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1175 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001176
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001177tune.chksize <number>
1178 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1179 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1180 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1181 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1182 checks whenever possible.
1183
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001184tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1185 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1186 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1187 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1188 this value. The default value is 1.
1189
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001190tune.http.cookielen <number>
1191 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1192 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1193 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1194 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1195 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1196 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1197 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1198 to change this value.
1199
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001200tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1202 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1203 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1204 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1205 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1206 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1207 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1208 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1209 limit too high.
1210
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001211tune.idletimer <timeout>
1212 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1213 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1214 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1215 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1216 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1217 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1218 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1219 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1220 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1221
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001222tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1223 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1224 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1225 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1226 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1227 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1228 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1229 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1230
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001231tune.lua.maxmem
1232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1233 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1234 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1235 memory.
1236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001237tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1238 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001239 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1240 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1241 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242
1243tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1244 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1245 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1246 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1247 check servers.
1248
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001249tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1250 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1251 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1252 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1253 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1254
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001255tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001256 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1257 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1258 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1259 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1260 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1261 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1262 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1263 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1264 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1265 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001266
1267tune.maxpollevents <number>
1268 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1269 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1270 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1271 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1272 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1273
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001274tune.maxrewrite <number>
1275 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1276 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1277 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1278 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1279 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1280 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1281 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1282 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1283 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1284 bufsize.
1285
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001286tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1287 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1288 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1289 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1290 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1291 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1292 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1293 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1294 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1295 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1296 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1297 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1298 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1299 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1300 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1301 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1302 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1303 setting this parameter to 0.
1304
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001305tune.pipesize <number>
1306 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1307 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1308 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1309 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1310 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1311 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1312
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001313tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1314tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1315 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1316 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1317 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1318 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1319 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1320 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1321 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1322
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001323tune.recv_enough <number>
1324 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1325 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1326 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1327 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1328 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1329
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001330tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1331tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1332 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1333 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1334 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1335 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1336 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1337 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1338 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1339 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1340 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1341 notifying haproxy again.
1342
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001343tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1345 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1346 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001347 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001348 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1349 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1350 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1351 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1352 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001353 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1354 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001355
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001356tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1357 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1358 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1359 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1360 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1361 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1362 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1363
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001364tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1365 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001367 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1368 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1369 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1370 being used for too long.
1371
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001372tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1373 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1374 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1375 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1376 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1377 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1378 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1379 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1380 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1381 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1382 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001383 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1384 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001385
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001386tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1387 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1388 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1389 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1390 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1391 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1392 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1393 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001394 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1395 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001396
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001397tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1398 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1399 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1400 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1401 1000 entries.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001403tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1404tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1405tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1406tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001407 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1408 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1409 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1410 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1411 response processing.
1412 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1413 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1414 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001416 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1417 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1418 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1419 all available space is consumed.
1420 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1421 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1422 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001423
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001424tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1425 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001426 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001427 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1428 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1429 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1430
1431tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1432 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1433 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1434 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1435 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.3. Debugging
1438--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
1440debug
1441 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1442 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1443 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1444 system startup.
1445
1446quiet
1447 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1448 line argument "-q".
1449
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014513.4. Userlists
1452--------------
1453It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1454http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1455it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1456
1457userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1460
1461group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001462 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001463 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1464 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001466user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1467 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1469 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001470 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1471 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001472 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001473 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
1475
1476 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 userlist L1
1478 group G1 users tiger,scott
1479 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1482 user scott insecure-password elgato
1483 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 userlist L2
1486 group G1
1487 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001489 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1490 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1491 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001492
1493 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001495
14963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001498It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1499several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1500instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1501values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1502automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1503In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1504using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1505tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1506reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1507Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1508that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1509each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001510
1511peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001512 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1514
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001515disabled
1516 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1517 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1518 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1519
1520enable
1521 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1522
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001523peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1524 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1525 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1526 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1527 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1528 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1529 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1530
1531 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1532 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1533
1534 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1535 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1536 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1537 across all peers.
1538
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1540 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1545 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1546 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001547
1548 backend mybackend
1549 mode tcp
1550 balance roundrobin
1551 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1552 stick on src
1553
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001554 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1555 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001556
1557
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015583.6. Mailers
1559------------
1560It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1561If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1562in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1563
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001564mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001565 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1566 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1567
1568mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1569 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1570
1571 Example:
1572 mailers mymailers
1573 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1574 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1575
1576 backend mybackend
1577 mode tcp
1578 balance roundrobin
1579
1580 email-alert mailers mymailers
1581 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1582 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1583
1584 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1585 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1586
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001587timeout mail <time>
1588 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1589 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1590 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1591 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 mailers mymailers
1595 timeout mail 20s
1596 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001602 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603 - frontend <name>
1604 - backend <name>
1605 - listen <name>
1606
1607A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1608its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1609section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1613connections.
1614
1615A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1616to forward incoming connections.
1617
1618A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1619parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1622'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1623case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1624
1625Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1626logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1627proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1628However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1629name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1630
1631Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1632and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001633bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1635modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1636arbitrary criteria.
1637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001638In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1639a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1640the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1641
1642 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1643 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1644 between responses and new requests.
1645
1646 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1647 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1648 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1649 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1650
1651 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1652 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1653 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1654
1655 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1656 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1657 client-facing connection remains open.
1658
1659 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1660 after the end of the response.
1661
1662The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1663frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1664following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1665weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1666
1667 Backend mode
1668
1669 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1674 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1676 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1677 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1678 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1679 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1684--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1687limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1688they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1689limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001692and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1693with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1694specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1699acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001700appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701backlog X X X -
1702balance X - X X
1703bind - X X -
1704bind-process X X X X
1705block - X X X
1706capture cookie - X X -
1707capture request header - X X -
1708capture response header - X X -
1709clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001710compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1712cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001713declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714default-server X - X X
1715default_backend X X X -
1716description - X X X
1717disabled X X X X
1718dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001719email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001720email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001721email-alert mailers X X X X
1722email-alert myhostname X X X X
1723email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724enabled X X X X
1725errorfile X X X X
1726errorloc X X X X
1727errorloc302 X X X X
1728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1729errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001730force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001731filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732fullconn X - X X
1733grace X X X X
1734hash-type X - X X
1735http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001736http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001737http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001739http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001740http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001741http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001743ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001745log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001746log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001747log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001748log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001749max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750maxconn X X X -
1751mode X X X X
1752monitor fail - X X -
1753monitor-net X X X -
1754monitor-uri X X X -
1755option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1756option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1757option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1758option allbackups (*) X - X X
1759option checkcache (*) X - X X
1760option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1761option contstats (*) X X X -
1762option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1763option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1764option forceclose (*) X X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1766option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001767option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001768option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001769option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001770option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001771option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001772option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001773option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1775option httpchk X - X X
1776option httpclose (*) X X X X
1777option httplog X X X X
1778option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001780option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001781option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1783option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1784option logasap (*) X X X -
1785option mysql-check X - X X
1786option nolinger (*) X X X X
1787option originalto X X X X
1788option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001789option pgsql-check X - X X
1790option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001792option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793option smtpchk X - X X
1794option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1795option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1796option splice-request (*) X X X X
1797option splice-response (*) X X X X
1798option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1799option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001801option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001802option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1803option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1804option tcpka X X X X
1805option tcplog X X X X
1806option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001807external-check command X - X X
1808external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1810rate-limit sessions X X X -
1811redirect - X X X
1812redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1813redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1814reqadd - X X X
1815reqallow - X X X
1816reqdel - X X X
1817reqdeny - X X X
1818reqiallow - X X X
1819reqidel - X X X
1820reqideny - X X X
1821reqipass - X X X
1822reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823reqitarpit - X X X
1824reqpass - X X X
1825reqrep - X X X
1826-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827reqtarpit - X X X
1828retries X - X X
1829rspadd - X X X
1830rspdel - X X X
1831rspdeny - X X X
1832rspidel - X X X
1833rspideny - X X X
1834rspirep - X X X
1835rsprep - X X X
1836server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001837server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838source X - X X
1839srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001840stats admin - X X X
1841stats auth X X X X
1842stats enable X X X X
1843stats hide-version X X X X
1844stats http-request - X X X
1845stats realm X X X X
1846stats refresh X X X X
1847stats scope X X X X
1848stats show-desc X X X X
1849stats show-legends X X X X
1850stats show-node X X X X
1851stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1853stick match - - X X
1854stick on - - X X
1855stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001856stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001858tcp-check connect - - X X
1859tcp-check expect - - X X
1860tcp-check send - - X X
1861tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001862tcp-request connection - X X -
1863tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001864tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001865tcp-response content - - X X
1866tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout check X - X X
1868timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001869timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1871timeout connect X - X X
1872timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1873timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1874timeout http-request X X X X
1875timeout queue X - X X
1876timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001877timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001880timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001882unique-id-format X X X -
1883unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001885use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1891---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1894
1895
1896acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1897 Declare or complete an access list.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | yes
1900 Example:
1901 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1902 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1903 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001908appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1909 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | no | yes | yes
1913 Arguments :
1914 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1915 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1916
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001917 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 checked in each cookie value.
1919
1920 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1921 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1922 milliseconds.
1923
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001924 request-learn
1925 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1926 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1927 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1928 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1929 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1930 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1931
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001932 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1933 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1934 data following this prefix.
1935
1936 Example :
1937 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1938
1939 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1940 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1941
1942 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1943 2 modes are currently supported :
1944 - path-parameters :
1945 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1946 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1947 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1948 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1949 - query-string :
1950 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1951 query string.
1952
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001953 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1954 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1955 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001957 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1958 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001961backlog <conns>
1962 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 yes | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1967 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001968 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001969
1970 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1971 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1972 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1973 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1974 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1975 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1976 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1977 backlog parameter.
1978
1979 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1980 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1981 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1982
1983 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1993 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1994 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1995 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1996
1997 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1998 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1999 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2000 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002001 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002002 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002003 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2004 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2005 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2006 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2007 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2008 it, so that you don't worry.
2009
2010 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2011 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2012 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2013 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2014 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2015 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2016 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2017 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002019 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2020 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2021 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2022 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2023 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2024 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2025 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2026 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2027
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002029 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002030 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2031 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002032 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2034 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2035 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2036 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2037 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2039 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2040 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2041 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2042 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2043 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2046 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2047 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2048 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2049 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2050 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2051 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2052 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002053 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002055 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2056 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2057 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002059 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2060 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2061 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2062 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2063 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2064 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2065 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2066 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2067 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2068 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2069 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2070 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002072 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002073 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2074 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2075 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2076 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2077 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2078 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2079 URIs start with a leading "/".
2080
2081 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2082 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2083 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2084 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002087 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2088
2089 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002090 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2091 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2093 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2094 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2095 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2098 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002099
2100 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2101 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2102 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2103 server will receive the request.
2104
2105 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2106 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2107 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2108 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2109 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002110 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2111 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2112 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002114 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2115 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2116 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2117 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2118 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002120 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002121 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2122 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2123 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2124
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002125 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2126 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2127 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2128
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002129 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002130 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002131 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2132 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2133 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2134 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2135 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2136 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002137 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002138 used instead.
2139
2140 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2141 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2142 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2143 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2144
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002145 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2146 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2147 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2148
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002149 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002152 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2153 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002154
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002155 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2156 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2157 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 Examples :
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002162 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002163 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2164 balance hdr(host)
2165 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166
2167 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2168 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002170 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2172 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2173 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2174 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2175
2176 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2177 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2178 defaults to 16 kB.
2179
2180 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2181 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2182
2183 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2184 Round Robin.
2185
2186 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2187 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2188 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2189 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2190
2191 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2192
2193 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002195 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2196 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2197 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2203bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | no
2207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002208 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2209 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2210 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2211 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002212 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002213 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2214 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2215 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2216 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2221 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2222 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2223 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2224 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2225 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2226 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002227 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2228 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2229 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2232 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002233
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2235 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002236 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2237 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2238 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2240 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2241 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2242 the range.
2243
2244 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2245 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2246 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2247 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2248 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2249 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2250 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002251 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002252 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002254 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2255 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2256 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2257 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2258 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2259 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2260 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2261 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2262
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002263 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2264 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2265 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2266 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2269 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2270 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2271 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2272 in a frontend.
2273
2274 Example :
2275 listen http_proxy
2276 bind :80,:443
2277 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002278 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002280 listen http_https_proxy
2281 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002282 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002283
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002284 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2285 bind ipv6@:80
2286 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2287 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2288
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002289 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002290 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002291
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002292 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2293 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2294 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2295 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2296 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2297
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002298 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002299 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 yes | yes | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2308 may be used to override a default value.
2309
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002310 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002311 option may be combined with other numbers.
2312
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002313 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002314 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2315 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2316 missing from all processes.
2317
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002318 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002320 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2321 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2322 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2323 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
2325 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2326 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2327 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2328 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2329 and 'even' instances.
2330
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002331 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2332 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2333 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2334 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002336 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2337 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2338
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002339 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2340 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2341 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2342
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2344 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2345
2346 Example :
2347 listen app_ip1
2348 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002349 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002350
2351 listen app_ip2
2352 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002353 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002354
2355 listen management
2356 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002357 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002358
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002359 listen management
2360 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2361 bind-process 1-4
2362
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002363 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366block { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2372 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002374 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2376 "block" statements per instance.
2377
2378 Example:
2379 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2380 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2381 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2382 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
2386
2387capture cookie <name> len <length>
2388 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 no | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2393 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2394 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2395 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2396 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2397
2398 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2399 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2400 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2401 right if it exceeds <length>.
2402
2403 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2404 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2405 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2406 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2407
2408 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2409 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2410 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2411
2412 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2413 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2414 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002415 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2416 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2417 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419 Example:
2420 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2421
2422 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002423 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425
2426capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002427 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | no
2430 Arguments :
2431 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2434 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2435 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2436
2437 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2438 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2439 it exceeds <length>.
2440
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002441 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2443 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2445 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2446 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2447 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 environments to find where the request came from.
2450
2451 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2452 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2453 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2454 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002456 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2457 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2458 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2459 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2460 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 Example:
2463 capture request header Host len 15
2464 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002465 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002467 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 about logging.
2469
2470
2471capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002472 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
2475 Arguments :
2476 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002477 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2479 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2480 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2481
2482 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2483 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2484 it exceeds <length>.
2485
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002486 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2488 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2489 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002490 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2491 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2492 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2493 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002495 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2496 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2497 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2498 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2499 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
2501 Example:
2502 capture response header Content-length len 9
2503 capture response header Location len 15
2504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002505 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 about logging.
2507
2508
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002509clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | no
2513 Arguments :
2514 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2516 as explained at the top of this document.
2517
2518 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2519 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2520 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2521 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2522 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2538 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2539
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2541 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002543compression algo <algorithm> ...
2544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002546 Enable HTTP compression.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2553
2554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561
2562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002585
2586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2601 "Accept-Encoding" header
2602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002603 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002604 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2605 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2607 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2608 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2609 "multipart"
2610 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2611 header
2612 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2613 and later
2614 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2615 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002616
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002617 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2618 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002619
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002620 Examples :
2621 compression algo gzip
2622 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002625contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | no | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2632 as explained at the top of this document.
2633
2634 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002636 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2638 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2639 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2640 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2641
2642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2648
2649 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2650 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2651 instead.
2652
2653 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2654 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2655
2656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002657cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002658 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2659 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | no | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2673
2674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2682 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
2686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
2701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2735
2736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2743 persistence cookie in the cache.
2744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2755 they logout.
2756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2761
2762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2767 this attribute.
2768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2786 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2792 the site.
2793
2794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2807 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2812 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2813 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2814 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 Examples :
2817 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2819 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002820 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002822 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002824
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002825declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2826 Declares a capture slot.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 no | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments:
2830 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2831
2832 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2833 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2834 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2835 for use in the response.
2836
2837 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002838 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002839 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2840
2841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002842default-server [param*]
2843 Change default options for a server in a backend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2848 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2849 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2850 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002853 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2854
2855 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858default_backend <backend>
2859 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | yes | yes | no
2862 Arguments :
2863 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2864
2865 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2866 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2867 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2868 will catch all undetermined requests.
2869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Example :
2871
2872 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2873 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2874 default_backend dynamic
2875
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002876 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002879description <string>
2880 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : string
2884
2885 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2886 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2887 it describes.
2888 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891disabled
2892 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2898 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2899 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2900 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2901 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2902 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2903 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2904
2905 See also : "enabled"
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002908dispatch <address>:<port>
2909 Set a default server address
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913
2914 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2915 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2916 during start-up.
2917
2918 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2919 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2920 possible with normal servers.
2921
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002922 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002923 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2924 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2925 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2926 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2927
2928 See also : "server"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931enabled
2932 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2938 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2939
2940 See also : "disabled"
2941
2942
2943errorfile <code> <file>
2944 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | yes
2947 Arguments :
2948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002949 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2950 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002953 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002955 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2956 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2965 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2966 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2967 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2968
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002969 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2970 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2971 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2972 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2973 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2974 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2977 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2978 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002979 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2981
2982 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2983
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002984 Example :
2985 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002986 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002987 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2988 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990
2991errorloc <code> <url>
2992errorloc302 <code> <url>
2993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments :
2997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
3000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3005
3006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3009
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003010 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3013 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3014 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3015 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003016 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3018 request.
3019
3020 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3021
3022
3023errorloc303 <code> <url>
3024 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3029 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3030
3031 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3032 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3033 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3034 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3035 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3036
3037 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3038 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3039 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3040
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003041 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3042
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003043 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3044 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3045 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3046 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003047 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048
3049 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3050
3051
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003052email-alert from <emailaddr>
3053 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3054 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003065 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003066 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3067 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068
3069
3070email-alert level <level>
3071 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3072 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075
3076 Arguments :
3077
3078 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3079 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3080 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3081
3082 By default level is alert
3083
3084 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3085 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3086 for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003088 Alerts are sent when :
3089
3090 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3091 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3092 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3093 is notice or lower
3094 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3095 and a health check status update occurs
3096
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003097 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3098 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099 section 3.6 about mailers.
3100
3101
3102email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3103 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106
3107 Arguments :
3108
3109 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3110
3111 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3112 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3113
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003114 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3115 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
3117
3118email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3119 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3120 mailers.
3121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123
3124 Arguments :
3125
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003126 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
3128 By default the systems hostname is used.
3129
3130 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3131 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3132 for the proxy.
3133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003136
3137
3138email-alert to <emailaddr>
3139 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3140 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143
3144 Arguments :
3145
3146 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3147
3148 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3149 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3150
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003151 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003155force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3156 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3161 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3162 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3163 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3164 marked down for maintenance operations.
3165
3166 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3167 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3168 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3169 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3170 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3171 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3172 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3173 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3174 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3175
3176 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3177 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3178 is used.
3179
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003180 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003181 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003183
3184filter <name> [param*]
3185 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3190 referenced in section 9.
3191
3192 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3193 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3194 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3195 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3196
3197 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3198 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3199
3200 Example:
3201 listen
3202 bind *:80
3203
3204 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3205 filter compression
3206 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3207
3208 compression algo gzip
3209 compression offload
3210
3211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3212
3213 See also : section 9.
3214
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216fullconn <conns>
3217 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3222 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3223
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003224 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003226 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3228 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3229 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3230 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3231 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003232 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003234 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3235 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003236 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3237 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3238 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240 Example :
3241 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3242 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3243 # connections.
3244 backend dynamic
3245 fullconn 10000
3246 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3247 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3248
3249 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3250
3251
3252grace <time>
3253 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003256 Arguments :
3257 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3258 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3259 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3260
3261 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3262 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003263 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3265
3266 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3267 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3268 simplify it.
3269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003271hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | no | yes | yes
3275 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003276 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3277 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003279 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3280 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3281 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3282 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3283 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3284 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3285 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3286 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3287 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3288 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003289
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3296 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3297 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3298 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3299 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3300 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3301 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3302 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3304 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003305
3306 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003309 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3310 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3311 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003312 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3313 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3314 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315
3316 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3317 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3319 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3320 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3321 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3322
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003323 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3324 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3325 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3326 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3327 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3328 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3329 parameter.
3330
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003331 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3332 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3333 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3334 used on strings.
3335
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003336 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3337
3338 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3339 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3340 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3341 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3342 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3343 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3344 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3345 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3346 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3347 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3348 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3349 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003350
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003351 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3352 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3353 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003354
3355 See also : "balance", "server"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358http-check disable-on-404
3359 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Arguments : none
3363
3364 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3365 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3366 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3367 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3368 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3369 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3370 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3371 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3373 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3374 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3375
3376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3377
3378
3379http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003383 Arguments :
3384 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3385 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3388 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3389 details on the supported keywords.
3390
3391 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3392 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3393 with the usual backslash ('\').
3394
3395 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3396 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3397 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3398 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3399 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3400
3401 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003403 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3404 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3405 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3406
3407 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3410 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3413
3414 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003416 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3417 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3418 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3419 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3420 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3421 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3422 trace).
3423
3424 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003426 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3427 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3428 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3429 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3430 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3431 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3432
3433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3436 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3437 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3441
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003442 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3443 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3444 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003446 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3447 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003451 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452
3453 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003454 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003455
3456 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003462 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003465http-check send-state
3466 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3472 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3473 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3474 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3475 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3476
3477 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3478 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3479 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3480 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3481 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003482 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3483 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3484 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3485
3486 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3487 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3488 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3489
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003490 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3491 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3492 checked in multiple backends.
3493
3494 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3495 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3496
3497 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3498 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3499 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3500 one fails.
3501
3502 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3503 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3504 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3505
3506 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3507 server's queue.
3508
3509 Example of a header received by the application server :
3510 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3511 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3512
3513 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3514
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003515http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003516 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003517 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003518 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003519 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3520 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003521 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3522 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003523 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3524 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3525 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003526 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003527 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003528 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003529 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003530 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003531 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003532 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003534 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3535
3536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 no | yes | yes | yes
3538
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003539 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3540 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3541 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3542 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3543 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003545 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3546 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3547 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3548
3549 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3550 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3551 are evaluated.
3552
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003553 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3554 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3555 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3556 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3557 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3558 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3559 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3560 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3561 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003562 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003563 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3564 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003565
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003566 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3567 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3568 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3569 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3570 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3571
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003572 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3573 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3574 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003575 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3576 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003577
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003578 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3579 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3580 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3581 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3582 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3583 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3584 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3585 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3586
3587 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3588 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3589 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003590 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3591 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003592
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003593 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3594 <name>.
3595
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003596 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3597 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3598 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3599 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3600 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3601 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3602 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3603 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3604
3605 Example:
3606
3607 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3608
3609 applied to:
3610
3611 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3612
3613 outputs:
3614
3615 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3616
3617 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3618
3619 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3620 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3621 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3622 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3623 header.
3624
3625 Example:
3626
3627 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3628
3629 applied to:
3630
3631 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3632
3633 outputs:
3634
3635 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3636
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003637 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3638 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3639 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3640 it.
3641
3642 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3643 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3644 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3645 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3646 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3647 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3648
3649 Example :
3650 # prepend the host name before the path
3651 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3652
3653 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3654 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3655 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3656 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3657 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3658 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3659 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3660 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3661
3662 Example :
3663 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3664 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3665
3666 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3667 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3668 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3669 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3670 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3671 "set-query".
3672
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003673 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3674 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3675 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3676 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3677 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3678 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3679 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3680 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3681
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003682 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3683 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3684 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3685 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3686 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3687 another equipment.
3688
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003689 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3690 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3691 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3692 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3693 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3694 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3695 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3696 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3697
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003698 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3699 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3700 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3701 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3702 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3703 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3704 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3705 admin privileges.
3706
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003707 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3708 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3709 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3710 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3711 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3712 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3713 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3714 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3715
3716 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3717 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3718 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3719 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3720 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3721 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3722
3723 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3724 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3725 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3726 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3727 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3728 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3729
3730 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3731 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3732 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3733 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3734 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3735 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3736 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3737 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3738 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3739
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003740 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003741 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3742 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3743 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3744 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3745 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3746 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3747 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3748 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3749 request header" for more information.
3750
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003751 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3752 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3753 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3754 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003755 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3756 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003757
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003758 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3759 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3760 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3761 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3762 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3763 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3764 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3765 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3766 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3767 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3768 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3769 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3770
3771 These actions take one or two arguments :
3772 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3773 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3774 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3775 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3776
3777 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3778 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3779 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3780 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3781
3782 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3783 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3784 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3785 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3786 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3787 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3788 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3789 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3790
3791 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3792 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3793 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3794 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3795 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003797 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3798 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3799 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3800 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3801 continues.
3802
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003803 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3804 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3805 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3806 the actions evaluation continues.
3807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003808 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3809 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3810 inline.
3811
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003812 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3813 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3815 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003816 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003818 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3820 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003822 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003823 and '_'.
3824
3825 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3826 followed by some converters.
3827
3828 Example:
3829
3830 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3831
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003832 - set-src <expr> :
3833 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3834 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3835 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3836 source IP for privacy.
3837
3838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3839 followed by some converters.
3840
3841 Example:
3842
3843 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3844 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3845
3846 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3847
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003848 - set-src-port <expr> :
3849 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3850 expression.
3851
3852 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3853 followed by some converters.
3854
3855 Example:
3856
3857 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3858 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3859
3860 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
3861 the source port to 0.
3862
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003863 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3864 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3865 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3866 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3867 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3868 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3869 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3870 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3871 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3872 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3873 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3874 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3875 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3876 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3877 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3878 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3879
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003880 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3881
3882 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3883 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003884 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3885 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3886
3887 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3888 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3889 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3890 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003891
3892 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003893 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3894 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3895 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003896
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003897 http-request allow if nagios
3898 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3899 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3900 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003901
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003902 Example:
3903 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003904 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003905
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003906 Example:
3907 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3908 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003909 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003910 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3911 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3912 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3913 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3914 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3915 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3916
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003917 Example:
3918 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3919 acl add path /addacl
3920 acl del path /delacl
3921
3922 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3923
3924 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3925 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3926
3927 Example:
3928 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3929 acl setmap path /setmap
3930 acl delmap path /delmap
3931
3932 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3933
3934 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3935 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3936
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003937 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3938 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003939
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003940http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003941 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003942 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003943 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3944 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003945 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003946 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3947 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3948 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3949 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003950 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003951 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003952 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003953 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003954 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003955 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003956 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003957 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3958
3959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3960 no | yes | yes | yes
3961
3962 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3963 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3964 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3965 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3966 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3967 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3968
3969 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3970 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3971 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3972 current section.
3973
3974 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3975 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3976 rules are evaluated.
3977
3978 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3979 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3980 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3981 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3982 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3983 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3984 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3985
3986 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3987 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3988 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3989 external users.
3990
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003991 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3992 <name>.
3993
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003994 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3995 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3996 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3997 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3998 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3999 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4000 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4001 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4002
4003 Example:
4004
4005 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4006
4007 applied to:
4008
4009 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4010
4011 outputs:
4012
4013 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4014
4015 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4016
4017 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4018 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4019 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4020 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4021 header.
4022
4023 Example:
4024
4025 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4026
4027 applied to:
4028
4029 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4030
4031 outputs:
4032
4033 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4034
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004035 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4036 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4037 adapted to the new code.
4038
4039 Example:
4040
4041 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4042 http-response set-status 431
4043
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004044 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4045 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4046 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4047 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4048 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4049 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4050 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4051 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4052
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004053 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4054 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4055 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4056 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4057 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4058 another equipment.
4059
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004060 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4061 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4062 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4063 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4064 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4065 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4066 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4067 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4068
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004069 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4070 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4071 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4072 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4073 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4074 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4075 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4076 admin privileges.
4077
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004078 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4079 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4080 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4081 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4082 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4083 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4084 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4085 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4086
4087 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4088 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4089 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4090 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4091 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4092 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4093
4094 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4095 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4096 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4097 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4098 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4099 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4100
4101 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4102 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4103 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4104 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4105 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4106 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4107 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4108 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4109 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4110
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004111 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4112 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4113 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4114 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4115 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4116 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4117 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4118 response header" for more information.
4119
4120 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4121 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4122 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4123 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4124 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004125 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4126 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004127
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004128 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4129 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4130 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4131 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4132 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4133 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4134
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004135 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4136 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4137 inline.
4138
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004139 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4140 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4141 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4142 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004143 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004144 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004145 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004146 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4147 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004148 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004149 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004150 and '_'.
4151
4152 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4153 followed by some converters.
4154
4155 Example:
4156
4157 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4158
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004159 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4160 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4161 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4162 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4163 continues.
4164
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004165 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4166 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4167 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4168 the actions evaluation continues.
4169
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004170 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4171 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4172 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4173 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4174 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4175 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4176 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4177 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4178 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4179 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4180 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4181 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4182 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4183 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4184 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4185 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4186
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004187 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4188
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004189 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004190 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4191 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004192 rules.
4193
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004194 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4195 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4196 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4197 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4198
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004199 Example:
4200 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4201
4202 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4203
4204 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4205 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4206
4207 Example:
4208 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4209
4210 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4211
4212 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4213 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4214
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004215 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4216 ACL usage.
4217
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004218
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004219http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4220 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4221
4222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | no | yes | yes
4224
4225 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4226 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4227 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4228 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4229 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4230 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4231
4232 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4233
4234 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4235 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4236 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4237 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4238 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4239 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4240 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4241 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4242 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4243 not checking any request past the first one.
4244
4245 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4246 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4247 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4248 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4249 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4250 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4251 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4252
4253 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4254 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4255 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4256 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4257 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4258 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4259 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4260 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4261 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4262 downsides of rare connection failures.
4263
4264 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4265 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4266 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4267 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4268 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4269 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4270 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4271 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4272 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4273 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4274 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4275 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4276
4277 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4278 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4279 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4280 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4281
4282 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4283 and are never shared ;
4284
4285 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4286 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4287 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4288 and are never shared ;
4289
4290 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4291 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4292 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4293
4294 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4295 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4296 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4297
4298 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4299
4300
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004301http-send-name-header [<header>]
4302 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4303
4304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 yes | no | yes | yes
4306
4307 Arguments :
4308
4309 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4310
4311 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4312 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4313 is added with the header string proved.
4314
4315 See also : "server"
4316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004317id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004318 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 no | yes | yes | yes
4321 Arguments : none
4322
4323 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4324 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4325 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004326
4327
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004328ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4329 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 no | yes | yes | yes
4332
4333 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4334 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4335 and running).
4336
4337 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4338 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4339 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004340 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004341 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4342
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004343 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4344 "unless" condition is met.
4345
4346 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4347
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004348load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4349 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4350 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4351 yes | no | yes | yes
4352
4353 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4354 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4355 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4356 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4357 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4358 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4359 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4360 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4361
4362 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4363 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004364 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004365
4366 Arguments:
4367 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4368 named "server-state-file".
4369
4370 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4371 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4372 name is used as a file name.
4373
4374 none don't load any stat for this backend
4375
4376 Notes:
4377 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4378 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4379 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4380
4381 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4382 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4383
4384 Example 1:
4385
4386 Minimal configuration:
4387
4388 global
4389 stats socket /tmp/socket
4390 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4391
4392 defaults
4393 load-server-state-from-file global
4394
4395 backend bk
4396 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4397 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4398
4399 Then one can run :
4400
4401 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4402
4403 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4404
4405 1
4406 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4407 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4408 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4409
4410 Example 2:
4411
4412 Minimal configuration:
4413
4414 global
4415 stats socket /tmp/socket
4416 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4417
4418 defaults
4419 load-server-state-from-file local
4420
4421 backend bk
4422 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4423 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4424
4425 Then one can run :
4426
4427 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4428
4429 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4430
4431 1
4432 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4433 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4434 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4435
4436 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4437 "show servers state"
4438
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004440log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004441log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004442no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004443 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4445 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004446
4447 Prefix :
4448 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4449 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4450 prefix does not allow arguments.
4451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004452 Arguments :
4453 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4454 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4455 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4456 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4457 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4458 parameter.
4459
4460 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4461 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4462
4463 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4464 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4465 standard syslog port).
4466
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004467 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4468 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4469 standard syslog port).
4470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004471 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4472 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4473 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4474 appropriately writeable).
4475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004476 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4477 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004478
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004479 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4480 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4481 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4482 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4483 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4484 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4485 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4486 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4487 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4488 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4489 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004491 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4492
4493 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4494 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4495 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4496
4497 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4498 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4499 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004500 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4501 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4502 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4503 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4504 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004505
4506 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4507
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004508 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4509 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4510 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004511
4512 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4513 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4514 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4515 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4516
4517 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4518 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004519
4520 Example :
4521 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004522 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4523 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004524 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004526
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004527log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004528 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004531
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004532 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4533 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4534 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4535 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4536 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004537
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004538log-format-sd <string>
4539 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | no
4542
4543 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4544 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4545 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4546 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4547 which covers the log format string in depth.
4548
4549 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4550 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4551
4552 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4553 log format to "rfc5424".
4554
4555 Example :
4556 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4557
4558
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004559log-tag <string>
4560 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | yes | yes | yes
4563
4564 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4565 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4566 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4567 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4568 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4569 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4570 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4571 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4572 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004573
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004574max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4575 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 yes | no | yes | yes
4578
4579 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4580 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4581 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4582 servers.
4583
4584 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4585 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4586 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4587 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4588 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4589 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4590 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4591 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4592 picking a different server.
4593
4594 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4595 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4596 even if they have to be queued.
4597
4598 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4599 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4600
4601
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004602maxconn <conns>
4603 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 yes | yes | yes | no
4606 Arguments :
4607 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4608 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4609 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4610 closes.
4611
4612 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4613 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4614 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4615 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004616 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4617 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4618 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4619 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004620
4621 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4622 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4623 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4624
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004625 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004627 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4628
4629
4630mode { tcp|http|health }
4631 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4633 yes | yes | yes | yes
4634 Arguments :
4635 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4636 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4637 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4638 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4639
4640 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4641 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4642 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4643 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4644 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4645
4646 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004647 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4648 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4649 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4650 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4651 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4652 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4653 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004655 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4656 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4657 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004659 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004660 defaults http_instances
4661 mode http
4662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004663 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004666monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004670 Arguments :
4671 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4672 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004673 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4675 backend and its backup.
4676
4677 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4678 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4679 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4680 servers in a list of backends.
4681
4682 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4683 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4684 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4685 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4686 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4687 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4688 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004689 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4690 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691
4692 Example:
4693 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004694 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4696 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4697 monitor-uri /site_alive
4698 monitor fail if site_dead
4699
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004700 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701
4702
4703monitor-net <source>
4704 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | yes | yes | no
4707 Arguments :
4708 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4709 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4710 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4711 followed by a mask.
4712
4713 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4714 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004715 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004716 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4717
4718 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4719 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4720 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4721 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004722 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4723 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4724 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004726 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4727 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4728 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4729 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4730 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4731 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004733 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4734 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004736 Example :
4737 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4738 frontend www
4739 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4740
4741 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4742
4743
4744monitor-uri <uri>
4745 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | no
4748 Arguments :
4749 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4750 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4751
4752 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4753 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4754 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4755 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4756 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4757 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4758 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4759 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4760
4761 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4762 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4763 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4764 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4765 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4766 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4767
4768 Example :
4769 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4770 frontend www
4771 mode http
4772 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4773
4774 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4775
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004776
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004777option abortonclose
4778no option abortonclose
4779 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments : none
4783
4784 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4785 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4786 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4787 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004788 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004789 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4790 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4791 encountered while delivering the response.
4792
4793 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4794 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4795 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4796 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4797 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4798 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004799 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004800 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004801 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004802 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4803 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4804 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4805
4806 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4807 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4808 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4809 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4810 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4811 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4812 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4813 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004814 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004815
4816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4818
4819 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4820
4821
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004822option accept-invalid-http-request
4823no option accept-invalid-http-request
4824 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | yes | yes | no
4827 Arguments : none
4828
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004829 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004830 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4831 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4832 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4833 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4834 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4835 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4836 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004837 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4838 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4839 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4840 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4841 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004842 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004843 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4844 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4845 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004846
4847 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4848 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4849 been confirmed.
4850
4851 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4852 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004853 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4854 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004855 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4856
4857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4859
4860 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4861 stats socket.
4862
4863
4864option accept-invalid-http-response
4865no option accept-invalid-http-response
4866 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4868 yes | no | yes | yes
4869 Arguments : none
4870
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004871 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004872 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4873 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4874 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4875 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4876 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4877 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4878 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004879 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4880 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4881 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004882
4883 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4884 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4885 been confirmed.
4886
4887 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4888 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4889 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4890 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4891
4892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4894
4895 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4896 stats socket.
4897
4898
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004899option allbackups
4900no option allbackups
4901 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4903 yes | no | yes | yes
4904 Arguments : none
4905
4906 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4907 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4908 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4909 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4910 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4911 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4912 order between the backup servers anymore.
4913
4914 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4915 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4916
4917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4919
4920
4921option checkcache
4922no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004923 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4925 yes | no | yes | yes
4926 Arguments : none
4927
4928 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4929 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004930 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004931 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4932 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004933 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004934
4935 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004936 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004937 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004938 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4939 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004940 to the client are :
4941 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004942 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004943 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004944 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4945 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4946 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4947 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4948 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4949 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4950 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4951 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4952 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4953 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4954 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4955
4956 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004957 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004958 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004959 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004960 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4961
4962 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4963 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004964 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004965 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4966
4967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4969
4970
4971option clitcpka
4972no option clitcpka
4973 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4975 yes | yes | yes | no
4976 Arguments : none
4977
4978 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4979 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4980 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4981 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4982
4983 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4984 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4985 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4986 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4987
4988 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4989 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4990 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4991 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4992 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4993
4994 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4995
4996 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4997 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4998 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4999
5000 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5001 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5002
5003 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5004
5005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005006option contstats
5007 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 yes | yes | yes | no
5010 Arguments : none
5011
5012 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5013 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5014 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5015 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5016 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5017 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5018 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5019
5020
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005021option dontlog-normal
5022no option dontlog-normal
5023 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 yes | yes | yes | no
5026 Arguments : none
5027
5028 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5029 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5030 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5031 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5032 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5033 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5034 logged.
5035
5036 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5037 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5038 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005040 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005041 logging.
5042
5043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005044option dontlognull
5045no option dontlognull
5046 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | yes | yes | no
5049 Arguments : none
5050
5051 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5052 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5053 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5054 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5055 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5056 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005057 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5058 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5059 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005060
5061 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5062 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5063 would not be logged.
5064
5065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5067
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005068 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5069 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005070
5071
5072option forceclose
5073no option forceclose
5074 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005077 Arguments : none
5078
5079 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5080 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5081 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5082 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5083 global session times in the logs.
5084
5085 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005086 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005087 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005088
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005089 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5090 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5091 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5092
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005093 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5094 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005096 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5097 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5098
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005099 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005100
5101
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005102option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005103 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5105 yes | yes | yes | yes
5106 Arguments :
5107 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5108 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005109 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005110 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005111
5112 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5113 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5114 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5115 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5116 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5117 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5118 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005119 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5120 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5121 possible that the client has already brought one.
5122
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005123 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005124 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005125 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5126 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005127 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5128 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005129
5130 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5131 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5132 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5133 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5134 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5135 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5136 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5137
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005138 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5139 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5140 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5141 are under the control of the end-user.
5142
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005143 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005144 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5145 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005146 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5147 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5148 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005149
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005150 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005151 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5152 frontend www
5153 mode http
5154 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5155
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005156 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5157 backend www
5158 mode http
5159 option forwardfor header X-Client
5160
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005161 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005162 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005163
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005164
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005165option http-buffer-request
5166no option http-buffer-request
5167 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | yes | yes | yes
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5173 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5174 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5175 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5176 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5177 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5178 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5179 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5180 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5181 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5182 default.
5183
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005184 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005185
5186
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005187option http-ignore-probes
5188no option http-ignore-probes
5189 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | yes | yes | no
5192 Arguments : none
5193
5194 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5195 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5196 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5197 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5198 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5199 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5200 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5201 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5202 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5203 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5204 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5205 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5206
5207 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5208 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5209 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5210 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5211 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5212 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5213 are often the only way to detect them.
5214
5215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5217
5218 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5219
5220
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005221option http-keep-alive
5222no option http-keep-alive
5223 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5225 yes | yes | yes | yes
5226 Arguments : none
5227
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005228 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5229 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5230 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5231 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5232 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5233 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5234 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5235
5236 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5237 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005238 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5239 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5240 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5241 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5242 situations where this option may be useful :
5243
5244 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5245 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5246
5247 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5248 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5249
5250 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5251 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5252 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5253 request.
5254
5255 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5256 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005257 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5258 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5259 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005260
5261 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5262 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5263
5264 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5265 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5266 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5267 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5268 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5269 not set.
5270
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005271 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5272 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005273 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005274 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005275
5276 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005277 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5278 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005279
5280
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005281option http-no-delay
5282no option http-no-delay
5283 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | yes | yes | yes
5286 Arguments : none
5287
5288 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5289 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5290 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5291 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5292 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5293 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5294 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5295 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5296 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5297 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5298 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5299 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5300 affected.
5301
5302 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5303 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5304 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5305 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5306 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5307 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5308 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5309 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5310 latency environments.
5311
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005312 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5313
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005314
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005315option http-pretend-keepalive
5316no option http-pretend-keepalive
5317 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | yes | yes | yes
5320 Arguments : none
5321
5322 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5323 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5324 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5325 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5326 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5327 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5328 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5329 consider the response complete.
5330
5331 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5332 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5333 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5334 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5335 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5336 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5337
5338 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5339 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5340 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5341 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5342 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5343 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5344 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5345
5346 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5347 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005348 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005349 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5350 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005351
5352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5354
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005355 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5356 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005357
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005358
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005359option http-server-close
5360no option http-server-close
5361 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | yes | yes | yes
5364 Arguments : none
5365
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005366 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5367 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5368 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5369 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5370 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5371 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5372 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5373 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5374 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5375 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5376 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5377 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5378 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5379 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5380 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5381 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005382
5383 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5384 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5385 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5386 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005387 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5388 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005389
5390 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5391 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005392 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5393 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005394 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5395 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005396
5397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5399
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005400 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005401 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5402 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005403
5404
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005405option http-tunnel
5406no option http-tunnel
5407 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5409 yes | yes | yes | yes
5410 Arguments : none
5411
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005412 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5413 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5414 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5415 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5416 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5417 "option http-tunnel".
5418
5419 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005420 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005421 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5422 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5423 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5424 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5425 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5426 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5427 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005428
5429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5431
5432 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5433 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5434 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5435
5436
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005437option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005438no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005439 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | yes | yes | no
5442 Arguments : none
5443
5444 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5445 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5446 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5447 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5448 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5449 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5450 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5451
5452 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5453 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005454 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5455 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5456 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005457
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005458 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5459 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5460 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5461 front of an existing proxy.
5462
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005463 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5464
5465 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5466 http-server-close".
5467
5468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005469option httpchk
5470option httpchk <uri>
5471option httpchk <method> <uri>
5472option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5473 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5475 yes | no | yes | yes
5476 Arguments :
5477 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5478 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5479 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5480 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5481 ones.
5482
5483 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5484 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5485 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5486
5487 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5488 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5489 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5490 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5491 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5492
5493 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5494 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5495 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5496 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5497 the lack of any response.
5498
5499 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5500
5501 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5502 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5503 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5504
5505 Examples :
5506 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5507 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5508 backend https_relay
5509 mode tcp
5510 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5511 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5512
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005513 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5514 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5515 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005516
5517
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005518option httpclose
5519no option httpclose
5520 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 yes | yes | yes | yes
5523 Arguments : none
5524
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005525 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5526 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5527 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5528 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005529 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005530 "option http-tunnel".
5531
5532 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5533 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5534 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5535 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5536 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5537 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5538 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5539 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005540
5541 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005542 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005543 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5544 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5545 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5546 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5547 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005548
5549 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5550 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005551 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5552 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005553 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5554 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005555
5556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5558
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005559 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5560 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005561
5562
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005563option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005564 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005567 Arguments :
5568 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5569 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5570 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5571 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5572 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005573
5574 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5575 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5576 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5577 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5578 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5579 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5580 ports.
5581
5582 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5583
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005584 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5585 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005587 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005588
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005589
5590option http_proxy
5591no option http_proxy
5592 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 yes | yes | yes | yes
5595 Arguments : none
5596
5597 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5598 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5599 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5600 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5601 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5602
5603 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5604 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005605 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5606 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005607
5608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5610
5611 Example :
5612 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5613 backend direct_forward
5614 option httpclose
5615 option http_proxy
5616
5617 See also : "option httpclose"
5618
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005619
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005620option independent-streams
5621no option independent-streams
5622 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | yes | yes | yes
5625 Arguments : none
5626
5627 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5628 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5629 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5630 receive data or not.
5631
5632 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5633 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5634 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5635 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5636 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5637 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5638 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5639 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5640 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5641 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5642 socket buffers.
5643
5644 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5645 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5646 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5647 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5648 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5649
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005650 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005651 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5652 deprecated.
5653
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005654 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005655
5656
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005657option ldap-check
5658 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 yes | no | yes | yes
5661 Arguments : none
5662
5663 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5664 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5665 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5666 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5667
5668 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5669 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5670
5671 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5672 configure it.
5673
5674 Example :
5675 option ldap-check
5676
5677 See also : "option httpchk"
5678
5679
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005680option external-check
5681 Use external processes for server health checks
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | no | yes | yes
5684
5685 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5686 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5687 command".
5688
5689 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5690
5691 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5692
5693
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005694option log-health-checks
5695no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005696 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5698 yes | no | yes | yes
5699 Arguments : none
5700
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005701 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5702 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5703 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005704
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005705 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5706 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5707 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5708 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5709 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5710
5711 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5712 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005713
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005714 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5715 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5716 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005717
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005718
5719option log-separate-errors
5720no option log-separate-errors
5721 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | yes | yes | no
5724 Arguments : none
5725
5726 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5727 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5728 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5729 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5730 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5731 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5732 provides very important information.
5733
5734 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5735 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5736 error logs.
5737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005738 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005739 logging.
5740
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005741
5742option logasap
5743no option logasap
5744 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 yes | yes | yes | no
5747 Arguments : none
5748
5749 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5750 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5751 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5752 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5753 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5754 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5755 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005756 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005757 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5758 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005760 Examples :
5761 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5762 mode http
5763 option httplog
5764 option logasap
5765 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5766
5767 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5768 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5769 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5770 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005772 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005773 logging.
5774
5775
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005776option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005777 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005780 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005781 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5782 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005783 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005784
5785 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5786 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5787 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5788 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5789 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5790 in the MySQL table, like this :
5791
5792 USE mysql;
5793 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5794 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5795
5796 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5797 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5798 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5799 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5800 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5801 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5802 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5803 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5804 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5805
5806 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5807 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005808
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005809 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005810
5811 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5812 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5813 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5814 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005815 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5816 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005817
5818 See also: "option httpchk"
5819
5820
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005821option nolinger
5822no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005823 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005824 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005826 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005827
5828 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5829 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5830 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5831 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5832 connections.
5833
5834 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5835 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5836 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5837 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5838 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5839 this too.
5840
5841 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5842 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5843 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5844
5845 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5846 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5847 for servers.
5848
5849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5851
5852
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005853option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5854 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | yes | yes | yes
5857 Arguments :
5858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5859 matching <network>
5860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5861 header name.
5862
5863 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5864 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5865 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5866 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5867 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5868 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5869 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5870 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5871 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5872 possible that the client has already brought one.
5873
5874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5875 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5876 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5877 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5878 header and requires different one.
5879
5880 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5881 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5882 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5883 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5884 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5885 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5886 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5887
5888 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5889 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5890 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5891 both are defined.
5892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005893 Examples :
5894 # Original Destination address
5895 frontend www
5896 mode http
5897 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5898
5899 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5900 backend www
5901 mode http
5902 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5903
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005904 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5905 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005906
5907
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005908option persist
5909no option persist
5910 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5911 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005913 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005914
5915 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5916 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5917 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5918 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5919 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5920 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5921 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5922 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5923 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5924 redirected to another valid server.
5925
5926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5928
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005929 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005930
5931
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005932option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5933 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | no | yes | yes
5936 Arguments :
5937 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5938 PostgreSQL server.
5939
5940 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5941 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5942 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5943 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5944
5945 See also: "option httpchk"
5946
5947
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005948option prefer-last-server
5949no option prefer-last-server
5950 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | no | yes | yes
5953 Arguments : none
5954
5955 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5956 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5957 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5958 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5959 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5960 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5961 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5962 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5963 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005964 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5965 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5966 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5967 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5968 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5969 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5970 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005971
5972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5974
5975 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5976
5977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005978option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005979option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005980no option redispatch
5981 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005984 Arguments :
5985 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5986 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5987 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5988 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5989 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5990 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5991 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5992 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5993 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005995
5996 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5997 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5998 be able to access the service anymore.
5999
6000 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6001 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6002
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006003 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006004 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6005 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006007 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6008 "redisp" keywords.
6009
6010 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6011 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6012
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006013 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006014
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006015
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006016option redis-check
6017 Use redis health checks for server testing
6018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6019 yes | no | yes | yes
6020 Arguments : none
6021
6022 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6023 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6024 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6025 find the "+PONG" response message.
6026
6027 Example :
6028 option redis-check
6029
6030 See also : "option httpchk"
6031
6032
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006033option smtpchk
6034option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6035 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6037 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006038 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006039 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6040 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6041 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6042
6043 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6044 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6045 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6046
6047 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6048 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6049 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6050 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6051 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6052 dead server.
6053
6054 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6055 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6056 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6057 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6058
6059 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6060 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6061 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6062 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006063 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006064
6065 Example :
6066 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6067
6068 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006071option socket-stats
6072no option socket-stats
6073
6074 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | yes | yes | no
6077
6078 Arguments : none
6079
6080
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006081option splice-auto
6082no option splice-auto
6083 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | yes | yes | yes
6086 Arguments : none
6087
6088 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6089 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6090 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6091 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006092 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006093 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6094 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6095 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6096 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6097
6098 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6099 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6100 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6101 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6102 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6103 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6104 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6105 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6106 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6107 keyword.
6108
6109 Example :
6110 option splice-auto
6111
6112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6114
6115 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6116 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6117
6118
6119option splice-request
6120no option splice-request
6121 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6123 yes | yes | yes | yes
6124 Arguments : none
6125
6126 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006127 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006128 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6129 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6130 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6131 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6132
6133 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6134
6135 Example :
6136 option splice-request
6137
6138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6140
6141 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6142 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6143
6144
6145option splice-response
6146no option splice-response
6147 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 yes | yes | yes | yes
6150 Arguments : none
6151
6152 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006153 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006154 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6155 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6156 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6157 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6158
6159 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6160
6161 Example :
6162 option splice-response
6163
6164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6166
6167 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6168 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6169
6170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006171option srvtcpka
6172no option srvtcpka
6173 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | no | yes | yes
6176 Arguments : none
6177
6178 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6179 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6180 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6181 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6182
6183 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6184 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6185 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6186 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6187
6188 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6189 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6190 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6191 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6192 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6193
6194 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6195
6196 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6197 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6198 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6199
6200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6202
6203 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6204
6205
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006206option ssl-hello-chk
6207 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | no | yes | yes
6210 Arguments : none
6211
6212 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6213 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6214 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6215 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6216 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6217 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6218 hello message.
6219
6220 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6221 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6222 messages, which is appreciable.
6223
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006224 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6225 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6226 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006227
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006228 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6229
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006230
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006231option tcp-check
6232 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | no | yes | yes
6235
6236 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6237 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6238
6239 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6240 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6241 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6242
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006243 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006244 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6245 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6246 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6247 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6248 only.
6249
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006250 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006251 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6252 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6253 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6254 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6255
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006256 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006257 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6258 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006259 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006260 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6261 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6262 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6263 the respective protocols.
6264 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6265 analysed.
6266
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006267 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6268 script.
6269
6270 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6271 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6272 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6273 The "comment" is of course optional.
6274
6275
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006276 Examples :
6277 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6278 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006279 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006280
6281 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6282 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006283 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006284
6285 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6286 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006287 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006288 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006289 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006290 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006291 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006292 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006293 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6294 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006295 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006296 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6297 tcp-check expect string +OK
6298
6299 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6300 (send many headers before analyzing)
6301 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006302 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006303 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6304 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6305 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6306 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006307 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006308
6309
6310 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6311
6312
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006313option tcp-smart-accept
6314no option tcp-smart-accept
6315 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6317 yes | yes | yes | no
6318 Arguments : none
6319
6320 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6321 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6322 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6323 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6324 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6325 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6326
6327 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6328 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6329 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6330 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6331
6332 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6333 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6334 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6335 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6336
6337 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6338 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6339 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6340
6341 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6342 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6343 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6344
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006345 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6346
6347
6348option tcp-smart-connect
6349no option tcp-smart-connect
6350 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | no | yes | yes
6353 Arguments : none
6354
6355 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6356 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6357 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6358 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6359 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6360
6361 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6362 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6363 complex.
6364
6365 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6366 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6367 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6368
6369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6371
6372 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6373
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006374
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006375option tcpka
6376 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | yes | yes | yes
6379 Arguments : none
6380
6381 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6382 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6383 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6384 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6385
6386 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6387 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6388 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6389 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6390
6391 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6392 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6393 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6394 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6395 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6396
6397 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6398
6399 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6400 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6401 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6402 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6403 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6404 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6405 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6406 backends.
6407
6408 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6409
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006410
6411option tcplog
6412 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | yes | yes | yes
6415 Arguments : none
6416
6417 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6418 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6419 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6420 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6421 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6422 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6423 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6424 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6425
6426 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006428 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006429
6430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006431option transparent
6432no option transparent
6433 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006436 Arguments : none
6437
6438 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6439 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6440 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6441 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6442 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6443 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6444 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6445 appropriate server.
6446
6447 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6448 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6449
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006450 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006451 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006452
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006453
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006454external-check command <command>
6455 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | no | yes | yes
6458
6459 Arguments :
6460 <command> is the external command to run
6461
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006462 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6463
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006464 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006465
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006466 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6467 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6468 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6469 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6470 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6471 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006472
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006473 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6474
6475 Environment variables :
6476 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6477 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6478
6479 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6480
6481 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6482
6483 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6484 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6485 for a UNIX socket).
6486
6487 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6488
6489 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6490
6491 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6492
6493 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6494
6495 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6496
6497 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6498 socket).
6499
6500 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6501 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6502
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006503 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6504 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6505 failed.
6506
6507 Example :
6508 external-check command /bin/true
6509
6510 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6511
6512
6513external-check path <path>
6514 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 yes | no | yes | yes
6517
6518 Arguments :
6519 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6520
6521 The default path is "".
6522
6523 Example :
6524 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6525
6526 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6527 "external-check command"
6528
6529
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006530persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006531persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006532 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6534 yes | no | yes | yes
6535 Arguments :
6536 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006537 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6538 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006539
6540 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6541 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6542 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6543 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6544 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6545 forwarded to this server.
6546
6547 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6548 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6549 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006550 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006551 a single "listen" section.
6552
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006553 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6554 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6555 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6556
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006557 Example :
6558 listen tse-farm
6559 bind :3389
6560 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6561 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6562 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6563 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6564 persist rdp-cookie
6565 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006566 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006567 balance rdp-cookie
6568 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6569 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6570
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006571 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6572 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006573
6574
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006575rate-limit sessions <rate>
6576 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6578 yes | yes | yes | no
6579 Arguments :
6580 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6581 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6582
6583 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6584 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6585 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6586 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6587 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6588 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6589
6590 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6591 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6592 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6593 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6594
6595 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6596 listen smtp
6597 mode tcp
6598 bind :25
6599 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006600 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006601
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006602 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6603 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6604 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006605
6606 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6607
6608
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006609redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6610redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6611redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006612 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6614 no | yes | yes | yes
6615
6616 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006617 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006618
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006620 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006621 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6622 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6623 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006624
6625 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6626 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6627 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6628 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6629 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006630 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6631 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6632 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6633 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006634
6635 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6636 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6637 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6638 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6639 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6640 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006641 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006642 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006643 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6644 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6645 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006646
6647 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006648 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6649 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6650 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006651 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006652 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6653 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6654 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6655 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006656
6657 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6658 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6659
6660 - "drop-query"
6661 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6662 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6663 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6664 with a location-type redirect.
6665
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006666 - "append-slash"
6667 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6668 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6669 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6670 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6671
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006672 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6673 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6674 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6675 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6676 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6677 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6678 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6679
6680 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6681 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6682 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6683 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6684 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6685 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6686 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006687
6688 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6689 acl clear dst_port 80
6690 acl secure dst_port 8080
6691 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006692 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006693 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006694 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6695
6696 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006697 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6698 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6699 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006700 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006701
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006702 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6703 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6704 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6705
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006706 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006707 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006708
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006709 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006710 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6711 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6712 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006714 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006715
6716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006717redisp (deprecated)
6718redispatch (deprecated)
6719 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006722 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006723
6724 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6725 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6726 be able to access the service anymore.
6727
6728 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6729 redistribute them to a working server.
6730
6731 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6732 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6733 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006735 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6736 "option redispatch" instead.
6737
6738 See also : "option redispatch"
6739
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006740
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006741reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006742 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6744 no | yes | yes | yes
6745 Arguments :
6746 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6747 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006748 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006749
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006750 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6751 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6752
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006753 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6754 the last header of an HTTP request.
6755
6756 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6757 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6758 responses.
6759
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006760 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6761 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6762 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6763
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006764 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6765 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006766
6767
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006768reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6769reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006770 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6772 no | yes | yes | yes
6773 Arguments :
6774 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6775 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6776 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6777 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6778 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6779 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6780 ignores case.
6781
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006782 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6783 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6784
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006785 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6786 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6787 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6788 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006789 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006790
6791 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6792 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6793
6794 Example :
6795 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6796 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6797 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6798
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006799 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6800 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006801
6802
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006803reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6804reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006805 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6807 no | yes | yes | yes
6808 Arguments :
6809 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6810 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6811 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6812 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6813 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6814 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6815
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006816 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6817 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6818
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006819 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6820 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6821 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6822 next servers.
6823
6824 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6825 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6826 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6827
6828 Example :
6829 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6830 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6831 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6832
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006833 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6834 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006835
6836
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006837reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6838reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006839 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6841 no | yes | yes | yes
6842 Arguments :
6843 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6844 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6845 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6846 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6847 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6848 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6849 case.
6850
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006851 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6852 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6853
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006854 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6855 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6856 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6857 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006858 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006859
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006860 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006861 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006862 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006863
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006864 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6865 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6866
6867 Example :
6868 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6869 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6870 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6871
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006872 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6873 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006874
6875
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006876reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6877reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006878 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 no | yes | yes | yes
6881 Arguments :
6882 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6883 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6884 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6885 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6886 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6887 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6888 case.
6889
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006890 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6891 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6892
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006893 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6894 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6895 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6896 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6897
6898 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6899 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6900
6901 Example :
6902 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6903 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6904 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6905 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6906
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006907 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6908 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006909
6910
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006911reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6912reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006913 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6915 no | yes | yes | yes
6916 Arguments :
6917 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6918 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6919 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6920 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6921 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6922 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6923
6924 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6925 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6926 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6927 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006928 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006929
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006933 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6934 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6935 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6936
6937 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6938 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6939 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6940 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6941 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6942
6943 Example :
6944 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006945 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006946 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6947 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6948
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006949 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6950 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006951
6952
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006953reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6954reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006955 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 no | yes | yes | yes
6958 Arguments :
6959 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6960 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6961 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6962 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6963 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6964 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6965 ignores case.
6966
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006967 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6968 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6969
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006970 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6971 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006972 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6973 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6974 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006975 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6976 not set.
6977
6978 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6979 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6980 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6981 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6982 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6983
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006984 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006985 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6986 # block all others.
6987 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6988 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6989
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006990 # block bad guys
6991 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6992 reqitarpit . if badguys
6993
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006994 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
6995 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006996
6997
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006998retries <value>
6999 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | no | yes | yes
7002 Arguments :
7003 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7004 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7005 default value is 3.
7006
7007 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7008 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7009 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7010
7011 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007012 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7013 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007014
7015 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7016 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7017
7018 See also : "option redispatch"
7019
7020
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007021rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007022 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7024 no | yes | yes | yes
7025 Arguments :
7026 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7027 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007028 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007029
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007030 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7031 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7032
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007033 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7034 the last header of an HTTP response.
7035
7036 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7037 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7038 responses.
7039
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007040 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7041 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007042
7043
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007044rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7045rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007046 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7048 no | yes | yes | yes
7049 Arguments :
7050 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7051 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7052 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7053 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7054 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7055 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7056 ignores case.
7057
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007058 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7059 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7060
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007061 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7062 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007063 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007064 client.
7065
7066 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7067 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7068 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7069
7070 Example :
7071 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007072 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007074 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7075 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007076
7077
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007078rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7079rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007080 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7082 no | yes | yes | yes
7083 Arguments :
7084 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7085 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7086 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7087 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7088 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7089 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7090 ignores case.
7091
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007092 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7093 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7094
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007095 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7096 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7097 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7098 case-sensitive.
7099
7100 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007101 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7102 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7103 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104
7105 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7106 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7107
7108 Example :
7109 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7110 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7111
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007112 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7113 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007114
7115
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007116rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7117rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007118 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 no | yes | yes | yes
7121 Arguments :
7122 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7123 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7124 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7125 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7126 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7127 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7128 ignores case.
7129
7130 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7131 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7132 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7133 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007134 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007135
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007136 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7137 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7138
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007139 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7140 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7141 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7142
7143 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7144 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7145 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7146 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7147 are not case-sensitive.
7148
7149 Example :
7150 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7151 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7152
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007153 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7154 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007155
7156
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007157server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007158 Declare a server in a backend
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 no | no | yes | yes
7161 Arguments :
7162 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007163 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007164 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007165
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007166 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7167 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7168 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7169 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007170 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7171 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7172 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7173 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7174 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007175 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7176 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7177 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7178 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7179 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7180 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7181 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007182 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007183 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7184 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7185 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007186
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007187 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007188 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7189 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7190 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7191 adding this value to the client's port.
7192
7193 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7194 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007195 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007196
7197 Examples :
7198 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7199 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007200 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007201 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7202 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7203 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007204
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007205 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7206 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7207 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7208 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7209 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7210
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007211 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7212 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007213
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007214server-state-file-name [<file>]
7215 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7216 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7217 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7218 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7219 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7220 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7221
7222 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7223 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7224
7225 global
7226 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7227
7228 backend bk
7229 load-server-state-from-file
7230
7231 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7232 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007233
7234source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007235source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007236source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007237 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | no | yes | yes
7240 Arguments :
7241 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7242 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007243
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007244 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007245 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7246 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7247 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7248 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7249 supported prefixes are :
7250 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7251 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7252 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007253 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007254 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7255 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007256
7257 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7258 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007259 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7260 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7261 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007262
7263 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7264 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7265 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7266 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7267 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7268 <addr>.
7269
7270 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7271 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7272 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7273 port.
7274
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007275 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7276 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7277 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7278 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007279 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007280 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7281 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7282 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7283 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7284 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7285 HTTP header.
7286
7287 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7288 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007289 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007290 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7291 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7292 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7293 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7294 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7295 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7296 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7297
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007298 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7299 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7300 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7301 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7302 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7303 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7304
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007305 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7306 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7307 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7308 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7309
7310 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7311 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7312 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7313 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7314 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7315 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7316
7317 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7318 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7319 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7320 there are two methods :
7321
7322 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7323 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7324 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7325 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7326 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7327 of the client ranges may be used.
7328
7329 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7330 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7331 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7332 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7333 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7334 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7335 same session.
7336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007337 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7338 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7339 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007340 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007341
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007342 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7343
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007344 Examples :
7345 backend private
7346 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7347 source 192.168.1.200
7348
7349 backend transparent_ssl1
7350 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7351 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7352
7353 backend transparent_ssl2
7354 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7355 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7356 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7357
7358 backend transparent_ssl3
7359 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7360 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7361 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7362
7363 backend transparent_smtp
7364 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7365 # with Tproxy version 4.
7366 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7367
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007368 backend transparent_http
7369 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7370 # proxy.
7371 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007373 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007374 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007376
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007377srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7378 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7380 yes | no | yes | yes
7381 Arguments :
7382 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7383 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7384 as explained at the top of this document.
7385
7386 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7387 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7388 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7389 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7390 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7391 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7392 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7393
7394 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7395 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7396 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7397 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7398 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007399 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007400 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007401 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007402
7403 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7404 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7405 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7406 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7407 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7408 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7409
7410 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7411 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7412
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007413 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7414 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007415
7416
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007417stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7418 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007420 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007421
7422 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7423 matched.
7424
7425 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7426 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7427
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007428 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7429 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7430 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7431
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007432 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7433 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7434 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7435 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007436
7437 Example :
7438 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7439 backend stats_localhost
7440 stats enable
7441 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7442
7443 Example :
7444 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7445 backend stats_auth
7446 stats enable
7447 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7448 stats admin if TRUE
7449
7450 Example :
7451 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7452 userlist stats-auth
7453 group admin users admin
7454 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7455 group readonly users haproxy
7456 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7457
7458 backend stats_auth
7459 stats enable
7460 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7461 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7462 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7463 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7464
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007465 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7466 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7467 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007468
7469
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007470stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7471 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007474 Arguments :
7475 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7476
7477 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7478
7479 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7480 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7481 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7482 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7483 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7484 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7485
7486 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7487 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7488 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007489 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007490
7491 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7492 report using "stats scope".
7493
7494 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7495 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7496 unobvious parameters.
7497
7498 Example :
7499 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7500 backend public_www
7501 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7502 stats enable
7503 stats hide-version
7504 stats scope .
7505 stats uri /admin?stats
7506 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7507 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7508 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7509
7510 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7511 backend private_monitoring
7512 stats enable
7513 stats uri /admin?stats
7514 stats refresh 5s
7515
7516 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7517
7518
7519stats enable
7520 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007523 Arguments : none
7524
7525 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7526 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7527 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7528 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7529 - stats auth : no authentication
7530 - stats scope : no restriction
7531
7532 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7533 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7534 unobvious parameters.
7535
7536 Example :
7537 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7538 backend public_www
7539 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7540 stats enable
7541 stats hide-version
7542 stats scope .
7543 stats uri /admin?stats
7544 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7545 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7546 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7547
7548 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7549 backend private_monitoring
7550 stats enable
7551 stats uri /admin?stats
7552 stats refresh 5s
7553
7554 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7555
7556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007557stats hide-version
7558 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007560 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007561 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007562
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007563 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7564 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7565 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7566 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7567 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7568 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007570 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7571 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7572 unobvious parameters.
7573
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007574 Example :
7575 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7576 backend public_www
7577 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007578 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007579 stats hide-version
7580 stats scope .
7581 stats uri /admin?stats
7582 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7583 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7584 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007585
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007586 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7587 backend private_monitoring
7588 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007589 stats uri /admin?stats
7590 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007591
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007592 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007593
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007594
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007595stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7597 Access control for statistics
7598
7599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7600 no | no | yes | yes
7601
7602 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7603 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7604 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7605 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7606 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7607 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7608
7609 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7610 instance.
7611
7612 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7613 about ACL usage.
7614
7615
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007616stats realm <realm>
7617 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007619 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007620 Arguments :
7621 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7622 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7623 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7624
7625 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7626 using a backslash ('\').
7627
7628 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7629 only related to authentication.
7630
7631 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7632 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7633 unobvious parameters.
7634
7635 Example :
7636 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7637 backend public_www
7638 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7639 stats enable
7640 stats hide-version
7641 stats scope .
7642 stats uri /admin?stats
7643 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7644 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7645 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7646
7647 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7648 backend private_monitoring
7649 stats enable
7650 stats uri /admin?stats
7651 stats refresh 5s
7652
7653 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7654
7655
7656stats refresh <delay>
7657 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007659 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007660 Arguments :
7661 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7662 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7663 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7664 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7665 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7666 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7667
7668 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7669 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7670 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7671 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7672
7673 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7674 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7675 unobvious parameters.
7676
7677 Example :
7678 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7679 backend public_www
7680 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7681 stats enable
7682 stats hide-version
7683 stats scope .
7684 stats uri /admin?stats
7685 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7686 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7687 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7688
7689 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7690 backend private_monitoring
7691 stats enable
7692 stats uri /admin?stats
7693 stats refresh 5s
7694
7695 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7696
7697
7698stats scope { <name> | "." }
7699 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007701 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007702 Arguments :
7703 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7704 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7705 section in which the statement appears.
7706
7707 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7708 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7709 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7710 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7711 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7712 exists.
7713
7714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7716 unobvious parameters.
7717
7718 Example :
7719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7720 backend public_www
7721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7722 stats enable
7723 stats hide-version
7724 stats scope .
7725 stats uri /admin?stats
7726 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7729
7730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7731 backend private_monitoring
7732 stats enable
7733 stats uri /admin?stats
7734 stats refresh 5s
7735
7736 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7737
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007738
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007739stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007740 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007744 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007745 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7746
7747 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7748 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7749
7750 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7751 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007752 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007753
7754 Example :
7755 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7756 backend private_monitoring
7757 stats enable
7758 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7759 stats uri /admin?stats
7760 stats refresh 5s
7761
7762 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7763 global section.
7764
7765
7766stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007767 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 yes | yes | yes | yes
7770 Arguments : none
7771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007772 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007773 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7774 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7775 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7776 - IP (socket, server)
7777 - cookie (backend, server)
7778
7779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007781 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007782
7783 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7784
7785
7786stats show-node [ <name> ]
7787 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007789 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007790 Arguments:
7791 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7792 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7793
7794 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7795 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007796 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007797
7798 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7799 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7800 unobvious parameters.
7801
7802 Example:
7803 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7804 backend private_monitoring
7805 stats enable
7806 stats show-node Europe-1
7807 stats uri /admin?stats
7808 stats refresh 5s
7809
7810 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7811 section.
7812
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007813
7814stats uri <prefix>
7815 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007818 Arguments :
7819 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7820 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7821 query string.
7822
7823 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7824 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7825 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7826 possible to reach it in the application.
7827
7828 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007829 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007830 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7831 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7832 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7833 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7834
7835 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7836 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7837 an address or a port to statistics only.
7838
7839 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7840 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7841 unobvious parameters.
7842
7843 Example :
7844 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7845 backend public_www
7846 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7847 stats enable
7848 stats hide-version
7849 stats scope .
7850 stats uri /admin?stats
7851 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7852 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7853 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7854
7855 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7856 backend private_monitoring
7857 stats enable
7858 stats uri /admin?stats
7859 stats refresh 5s
7860
7861 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7862
7863
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007864stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7865 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007867 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007868
7869 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007870 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007871 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7872 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7873 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7874
7875 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7876 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7877 the "stick-table" statement.
7878
7879 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7880 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7881 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7882 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7883 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7884
7885 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7886 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7887 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7888 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7889 transformation rules.
7890
7891 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7892 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7893 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7894 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7895 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7896 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7897 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7898
7899 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7900 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7901 ACL based conditions.
7902
7903 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7904 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7905 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7906 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7907
7908 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7909 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7910 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7911 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7912
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007913 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7914 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7915 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7916
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007917 Example :
7918 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7919 # last 30 minutes
7920 backend pop
7921 mode tcp
7922 balance roundrobin
7923 stick store-request src
7924 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7925 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7926 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7927
7928 backend smtp
7929 mode tcp
7930 balance roundrobin
7931 stick match src table pop
7932 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7933 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7934
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007935 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007936 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007937
7938
7939stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7940 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7942 no | no | yes | yes
7943
7944 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7945 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7946 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7947 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7948
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007949 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7950 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7951 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7952
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007953 Examples :
7954 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007955 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007956
7957 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7958 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7959 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7960
7961
7962 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7963 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7964 backend http
7965 mode http
7966 balance roundrobin
7967 stick on src table https
7968 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7969 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7970 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7971
7972 backend https
7973 mode tcp
7974 balance roundrobin
7975 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7976 stick on src
7977 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7978 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7979
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007980 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007981
7982
7983stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7984 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7986 no | no | yes | yes
7987
7988 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007989 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007990 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7991 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7992 server is selected.
7993
7994 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7995 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7996 the "stick-table" statement.
7997
7998 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7999 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8000 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8001 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8002 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8003 address.
8004
8005 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8006 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8007 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8008 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8009 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8010 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8011 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8012 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8013 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8014 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8015
8016 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8017 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8018 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8019 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8020 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8021 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8022 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8023
8024 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8025 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8026 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8027 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8028
8029 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8030 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8031 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8032 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8033 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8034 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008035 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8036 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8037 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8038 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8039 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8040 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008041
8042 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8043 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8044 the request.
8045
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008046 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8047 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8048 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8049
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008050 Example :
8051 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8052 # last 30 minutes
8053 backend pop
8054 mode tcp
8055 balance roundrobin
8056 stick store-request src
8057 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8058 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8059 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8060
8061 backend smtp
8062 mode tcp
8063 balance roundrobin
8064 stick match src table pop
8065 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8066 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8067
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008068 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008069 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008070
8071
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008072stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008073 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8074 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008075 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008077 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008078
8079 Arguments :
8080 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8081 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8082 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8083 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8084
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008085 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8086 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8087 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8088 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8089
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008090 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8091 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8092 instance.
8093
8094 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8095 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8096 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8097 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8098 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8099 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008100 to 32 characters.
8101
8102 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8103 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8104 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008105 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008106 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8107 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008108
8109 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008110 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8111 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008112 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8113 increase.
8114
8115 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008116 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8117 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8118 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008119
8120 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8121 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8122 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8123 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8124 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8125 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8126 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8127 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8128 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8129 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8130 parameter (see below).
8131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008132 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8133 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8134 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8135 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8136 soft restart.
8137
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008138 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8139 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008140
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008141 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8142 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8143 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8144 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8145 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008146 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008147 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8148 if not expiration delay is specified.
8149
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008150 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8151 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8152 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8153 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008154 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8155 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8156 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8157 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8158 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8159 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8160 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8161 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8162 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8163 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8164 types and their arguments.
8165
8166 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8167 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8168 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8169 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8170
8171 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8172 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8173 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8174 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8175
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008176 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8177 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8178 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8179 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8180 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8181 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8182
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008183 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8184 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8185 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8186 they were received.
8187
8188 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8189 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8190 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8191 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8192 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8193
8194 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8195 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8196 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8197 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8198 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8199
8200 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8201 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8202 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8203
8204 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8205 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8206 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8207 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8208 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8209
8210 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8211 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8212 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8213 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8214 the client side.
8215
8216 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8217 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8218 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8219 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8220 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8221 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8222 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8223
8224 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8225 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8226 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8227 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8228 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8229 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8230 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8231
8232 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8233 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8234 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8235 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8236 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8237 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8238
8239 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8240 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8241 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8242 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8243
8244 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8245 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8246 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8247 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8248 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8249 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8250 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8251 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8252 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8253 recommended for better fairness.
8254
8255 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8256 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8257 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8258 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8259
8260 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8261 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8262 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8263 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8264 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8265 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8266 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8267 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8268 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8269 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008270
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008271 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8272 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008273 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8274 reference it.
8275
8276 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8277 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008278 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8279 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8280 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008281
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008282 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8283 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8284 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8285 something that can be ignored.
8286
8287 Example:
8288 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8289 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8290 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8291 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8292
8293 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008294 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008295
8296
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008297stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008298 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8300 no | no | yes | yes
8301
8302 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008303 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008304 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8305 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8306 server is selected.
8307
8308 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8309 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8310 the "stick-table" statement.
8311
8312 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8313 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8314 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8315 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8316
8317 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8318 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8319 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8320 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8321 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8322 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008323 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008324 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8325 rules.
8326
8327 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8328 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8329 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8330 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8331 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8332 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8333 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8334
8335 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8336 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8337 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8338 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8339
8340 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8341 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8342 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8343 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8344 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8345 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008346 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8347 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8348 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8349 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8350 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8351 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8352 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8353 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8354 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008355
8356 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8357
8358 Example :
8359 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8360 backend https
8361 mode tcp
8362 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008363 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008364 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008365
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008366 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8367 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8368
8369 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8370 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8371 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8372
8373 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8374 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008375
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008376 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8377 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8378 # at offset 44.
8379
8380 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8381 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8382
8383 # Learn on response if server hello.
8384 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008385
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008386 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8387 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8388
8389 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8390 extraction.
8391
8392
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008393tcp-check connect [params*]
8394 Opens a new connection
8395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8396 no | no | yes | yes
8397
8398 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8399 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8400 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8401
8402 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8403 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8404 of the sequence.
8405
8406 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8407 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8408 do.
8409
8410 Parameters :
8411 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8412 use the TCP connection.
8413
8414 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8415 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8416 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8417
8418 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8419
8420 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8421
8422 Examples:
8423 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8424 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8425 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8426 option tcp-check
8427 tcp-check connect
8428 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8429 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8430 tcp-check send \r\n
8431 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8432 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8433 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8434 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8435 tcp-check send \r\n
8436 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8437 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8438
8439 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8440 option tcp-check
8441 tcp-check connect port 110
8442 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8443 tcp-check connect port 143
8444 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8445 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8446
8447 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8448
8449
8450tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8451 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8453 no | no | yes | yes
8454
8455 Arguments :
8456 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8457 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8458 binary.
8459 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8460 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8461 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8462
8463 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8464 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8465 with the usual backslash ('\').
8466 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8467 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8468 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8469 used upper or lower case.
8470
8471
8472 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8473
8474 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8475 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8476 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8477 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8478 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8479 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8480 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8481 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8482
8483 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8484 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8485 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8486 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8487 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8488 expression.
8489
8490 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8491 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8492 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8493 this exact hexadecimal string.
8494 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8495
8496 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8497 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8498 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8499 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8500 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8501 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8502 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8503 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8504 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8505 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8506 the null character.
8507
8508 Examples :
8509 # perform a POP check
8510 option tcp-check
8511 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8512
8513 # perform an IMAP check
8514 option tcp-check
8515 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8516
8517 # look for the redis master server
8518 option tcp-check
8519 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008520 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008521 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8522 tcp-check expect string role:master
8523 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8524 tcp-check expect string +OK
8525
8526
8527 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8528 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8529
8530
8531tcp-check send <data>
8532 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8534 no | no | yes | yes
8535
8536 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8537 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8538
8539 Examples :
8540 # look for the redis master server
8541 option tcp-check
8542 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8543 tcp-check expect string role:master
8544
8545 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8546 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8547
8548
8549tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8550 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8551 tcp health check
8552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 no | no | yes | yes
8554
8555 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8556 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8557 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8558 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8559 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8560 hexadecimal string.
8561 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8562
8563 Examples :
8564 # redis check in binary
8565 option tcp-check
8566 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8567 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8568
8569
8570 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8571 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8572
8573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008574tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8575 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8577 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008578 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008579 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8580 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008581
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008582 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008583
8584 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8585 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008586 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8587 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8588 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8589 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8590 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8591 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008593 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8594 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8595 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8596 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008597
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008598 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008599 - accept :
8600 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8601 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8602 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008604 - reject :
8605 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8606 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8607 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8608 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8609 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8610 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8611 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8612 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8613 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8614 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8615 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8616 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008617
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008618 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8619 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8620 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8621 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8622 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8623 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8624 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8625 hosts.
8626
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008627 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8628 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8629 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8630 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8631 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8632 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8633 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8634 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8635 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008636 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8637 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008638
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008639 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008640 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008641 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008642 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008643 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8644 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008645 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008646 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8647 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8648 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8649 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8650 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008651
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008652 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008653 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008654 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008655 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8656 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8657 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8658 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008660 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8661 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8662 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8663 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008665 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8666 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8667 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8668 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8669 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008670 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8671 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8672 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8673 layer7 information is extracted.
8674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008675 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8676 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8677 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8678 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8679 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008680
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008681 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8682 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8683 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8684 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8685
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008686 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8687 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8688 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8689 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8690 continues.
8691
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008692 - set-src <expr> :
8693 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8694 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8695 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8696 set-src"
8697
8698 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8699 followed by some converters.
8700
8701 Example:
8702
8703 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8704
8705 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8706
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008707 - set-src-port <expr> :
8708 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8709 expression.
8710
8711 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8712 followed by some converters.
8713
8714 Example:
8715
8716 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8717
8718 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8719 the source port to 0.
8720
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008721 - "silent-drop" :
8722 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8723 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8724 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8725 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8726 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8727 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8728 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8729 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8730 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8731 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8732 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8733 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8734 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8735 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8736 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8737 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8738
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008739 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8740 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8741 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008742
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008743 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8744 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8745 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008747 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008748 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008749 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008750
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008751 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8752 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8753 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008754
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008755 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008756 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8757 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008758
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008759 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8760
8761 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8762
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008763 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8764
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008765 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008766
8767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008768tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8769 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008771 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008772 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008773 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8774 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008775
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008776 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008777
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008778 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8779 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8780 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8781 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8782 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008784 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8785 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8786 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8787 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008788 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8789 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8790 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8791 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8792 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8793 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008794 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008795 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008797 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8798 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8799 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8800 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008801
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008802 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008803 - accept : the request is accepted
8804 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8805 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008806 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008807 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008808 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008809 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008810 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008812 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8813 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008814
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008815 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8816 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8817 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8818 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8819 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8820 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008822 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008823 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8824 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008826 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008827 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8828 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8829 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8830 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008831 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8832 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8833 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008834
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008835 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008836 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8837 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8838 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008839
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008840 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8841 declared inline.
8842
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008843 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8844 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8845 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8846 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008847 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008848 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008849 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008850 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8851 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008853 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8854 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008855
8856 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8857 followed by some converters.
8858
8859 Example:
8860
8861 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8862
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008863 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008864 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8865 # and reject everything else.
8866 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8867 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008868 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008869 tcp-request content reject
8870
8871 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008872 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8873 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8874 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008875 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008876
8877 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8878 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8879 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008880 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008881 tcp-request content reject
8882
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008883 Example:
8884 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8885 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008886 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008887
8888 Example:
8889 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8890 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008891 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008893 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8894 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8895
8896 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008897 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008898 # protecting all our sites
8899 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008900 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8901 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008902 ...
8903 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8904
8905 backend http_dynamic
8906 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008907 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008908 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008909 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8910 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8911 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008912 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008914 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008916 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008917
8918
8919tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8920 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008922 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008923 Arguments :
8924 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8925 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8926 as explained at the top of this document.
8927
8928 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8929 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8930 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8931 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8932 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8933
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008934 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8935 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8936 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8937 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008939 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8940 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008941 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008942 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008943 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8944 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8945 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8946 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008947
8948 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8949 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8950 it pass through unaffected.
8951
8952 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8953 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8954 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008955 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008956 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8957 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008958 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8959 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8960 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008961
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008962 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008963 "timeout client".
8964
8965
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008966tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8967 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8969 no | no | yes | yes
8970 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008971 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8972 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008973
8974 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8975
8976 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8977 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8978 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008979 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8980 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008981
8982 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8983
8984 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8985 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8986 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8987 inserted.
8988
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008989 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008990 - accept :
8991 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8992 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8993 the rules evaluation.
8994
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008995 - close :
8996 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8997 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8998 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8999 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9000 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9001 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009002 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009003 protocols.
9004
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009005 - reject :
9006 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9007 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009008 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009009
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009010 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9011 Sets a variable.
9012
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009013 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9014 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9015 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9016 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9017
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009018 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9019 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9020 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9021 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9022 continues.
9023
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009024 - "silent-drop" :
9025 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9026 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9027 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9028 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9029 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9030 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9031 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9032 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9033 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9034 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9035 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9036 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9037 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9038 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9039 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9040 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9041
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009042 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9043 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9044 for changing the default action to a reject.
9045
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009046 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9047 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9048 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9049 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009050 period.
9051
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009052 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9053 declared inline.
9054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009055 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9056 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9057 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9058 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009059 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009060 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009061 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009062 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9063 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009064 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009065 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9066 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009067
9068 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9069 followed by some converters.
9070
9071 Example:
9072
9073 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9074
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009075 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9076
9077 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9078
9079
9080tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9081 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9083 no | no | yes | yes
9084 Arguments :
9085 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9086 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9087 as explained at the top of this document.
9088
9089 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9090
9091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009092timeout check <timeout>
9093 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9094 established.
9095
9096 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | no | yes | yes
9098 Arguments:
9099 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9100 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9101 as explained at the top of this document.
9102
9103 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9104 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9105 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9106 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009107 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9108 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9109 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009110
9111 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9112 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9113
9114 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9115 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009116 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009117
9118 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9119 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9120 forget about it.
9121
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009122 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9123 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009124
9125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009126timeout client <timeout>
9127timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9128 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9130 yes | yes | yes | no
9131 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009132 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009133 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9134 as explained at the top of this document.
9135
9136 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9137 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9138 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009139 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9140 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9141 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9142 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009143 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9144 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9145 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009146 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009147 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009148 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9149 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009150 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9151 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009152
9153 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9154 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9155 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9156 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9157 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9158 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9159
9160 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9161 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9162 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9163
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009164 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9165 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009166
9167
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009168timeout client-fin <timeout>
9169 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9171 yes | yes | yes | no
9172 Arguments :
9173 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9174 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9175 as explained at the top of this document.
9176
9177 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9178 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9179 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9180 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9181 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9182 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9183 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9184 down in one direction.
9185
9186 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9187 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9188 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9189
9190 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9191
9192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009193timeout connect <timeout>
9194timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9195 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9197 yes | no | yes | yes
9198 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009199 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9201 as explained at the top of this document.
9202
9203 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009204 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009205 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009206 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009207 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9208 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009209
9210 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9212 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9213 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9214 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9215 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9216
9217 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9218 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9219 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9220
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009221 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9222 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009223
9224
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009225timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9226 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | yes | yes | yes
9229 Arguments :
9230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9232 as explained at the top of this document.
9233
9234 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9235 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9236 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9237 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9238 once the request has started to present itself.
9239
9240 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9241 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9242 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9243 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9244 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9245
9246 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9247 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9248 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9249 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9250
9251 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9252 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9253 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9254 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9255 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009256 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009257
9258 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9259 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9260 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9261 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9262
9263 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9264
9265
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009266timeout http-request <timeout>
9267 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009269 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009270 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9273 as explained at the top of this document.
9274
9275 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9276 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9277 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9278 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9279 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9280 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9281 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009282 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9283 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9284 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9285 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9286 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009287 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9288 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009289
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009290 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9291 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9292 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9293 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9294 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009295 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009296
9297 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9298 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9299 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9300 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9301 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9302
9303 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009304 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9305 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9306 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009307
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009308 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009309 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009310
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009311
9312timeout queue <timeout>
9313 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9315 yes | no | yes | yes
9316 Arguments :
9317 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9318 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9319 as explained at the top of this document.
9320
9321 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9322 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9323 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9324 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9325 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9326
9327 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9328 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9329 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9330 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9331
9332 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9333
9334
9335timeout server <timeout>
9336timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9337 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9339 yes | no | yes | yes
9340 Arguments :
9341 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9342 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9343 as explained at the top of this document.
9344
9345 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9346 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9347 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9348 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9349 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9350 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9351 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9352
9353 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9354 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9355 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9356 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9357 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009358 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009359 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009360 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9361 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9362 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9363 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009364
9365 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9366 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9367 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9368 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9369 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9370 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9371
9372 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9373 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9374 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9375
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009376 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009377
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009378
9379timeout server-fin <timeout>
9380 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9382 yes | no | yes | yes
9383 Arguments :
9384 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9385 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9386 as explained at the top of this document.
9387
9388 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9389 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9390 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9391 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9392 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9393 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9394 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9395 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9396 situations, it should not be needed.
9397
9398 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9399 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9400 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9401
9402 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9403
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009404
9405timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009406 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9408 yes | yes | yes | yes
9409 Arguments :
9410 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9411 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9412 as explained at the top of this document.
9413
9414 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9415 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9416 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9417
9418 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9419 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9420 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9421 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009422 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009423
9424 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9425
9426
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009427timeout tunnel <timeout>
9428 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | no | yes | yes
9431 Arguments :
9432 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9433 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9434 as explained at the top of this document.
9435
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009436 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009437 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9438 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9439 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9440 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9441 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9442 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9443 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9444 specified.
9445
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009446 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9447 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9448 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9449 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9450 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9451 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9452 state.
9453
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009454 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9455 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9456 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9457 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9458 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9459
9460 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9461 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9462 forget about it.
9463
9464 Example :
9465 defaults http
9466 option http-server-close
9467 timeout connect 5s
9468 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009469 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009470 timeout server 30s
9471 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9472
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009473 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009474
9475
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009476transparent (deprecated)
9477 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009479 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009480 Arguments : none
9481
9482 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9483 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9484 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9485 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9486 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9487 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9488 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9489 appropriate server.
9490
9491 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9492
9493 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9494 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9495
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009496 See also: "option transparent"
9497
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009498unique-id-format <string>
9499 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9501 yes | yes | yes | no
9502 Arguments :
9503 <string> is a log-format string.
9504
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009505 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9506 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9507 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9508 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009509
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009510 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9511 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9512 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9513 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9514 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9515 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9516 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9517 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009518
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009519 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9520 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009521
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009522 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009523
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009524 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009525
9526 will generate:
9527
9528 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9529
9530 See also: "unique-id-header"
9531
9532unique-id-header <name>
9533 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 yes | yes | yes | no
9536 Arguments :
9537 <name> is the name of the header.
9538
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009539 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9540 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009541
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009542 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009543
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009544 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009545 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9546
9547 will generate:
9548
9549 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9550
9551 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009552
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009553use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009554 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9556 no | yes | yes | no
9557 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009558 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9559 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009560
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009561 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9562 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009563
9564 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9565 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9566 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009567 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9568 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9569 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9570 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009571
9572 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9573 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9574 assign the backend.
9575
9576 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9577 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9578 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9579 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9580 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9581 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9582
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009583 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009584 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009585 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9586 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9587 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9588
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009589 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9590 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9591 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9592 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9593 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9594 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9595 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9596 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9597 cannot be forced from the request.
9598
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009599 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009600 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9601 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9602
9603 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9604 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009605
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009606
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009607use-server <server> if <condition>
9608use-server <server> unless <condition>
9609 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9611 no | no | yes | yes
9612 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009613 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009614
9615 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9616
9617 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9618 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9619 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9620
9621 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9622 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9623 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9624 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9625 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9626 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9627 matches will assign the server.
9628
9629 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9630 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9631 with the next rules until one matches.
9632
9633 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9634 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9635 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9636 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9637
9638 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9639 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9640 stripped.
9641
9642 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9643 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9644 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9645 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9646
9647 Example :
9648 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9649 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9650 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9651 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9652 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9653 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9654 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9655 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9656 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9657
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009658 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009659
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009660
96615. Bind and Server options
9662--------------------------
9663
9664The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9665depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9666settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9667written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9668described in this section.
9669
9670
96715.1. Bind options
9672-----------------
9673
9674The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9675as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9676no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9677parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9678while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9679provided immediately after the setting name.
9680
9681The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9682
9683accept-proxy
9684 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009685 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9686 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009687 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9688 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9689 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9690 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9691 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9692 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9693 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009694 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9695 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009696
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009697alpn <protocols>
9698 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9699 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9700 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9701 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9702 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9703 initial NPN extension.
9704
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009705backlog <backlog>
9706 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9707 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9708
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009709ecdhe <named curve>
9710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009711 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9712 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009713
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009714ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9716 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9717 client's certificate.
9718
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009719ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9721 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9722 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9723 error is ignored.
9724
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009725ca-sign-file <cafile>
9726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9727 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9728 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9729 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9730 'generate-certificates' for details.
9731
9732ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9734 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9735 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9736 'generate-certificates' for details.
9737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009738ciphers <ciphers>
9739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9740 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009741 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009742 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9743 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9744
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009745crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9747 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9748 to verify client's certificate.
9749
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009750crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9752 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9753 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9754 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9755 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9756 file.
9757
9758 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9759 are loaded.
9760
9761 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009762 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009763 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9764 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9765 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9766 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9767 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9768 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9769 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009770
9771 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9772 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9773 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9774 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009775 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9776 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009777
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009778 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009779
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009780 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9781 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009782 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009783 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9784 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9785 clients).
9786
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009787 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9788 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9789 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9790 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9791 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9792 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9793 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9794 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9795 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9796 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9797 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9798 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9799 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9800
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009801 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9802 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9803 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9804 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9805 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9806
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009807 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9808 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9809 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9810 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009811
9812 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9813 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9814 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9815 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9816 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9817 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9818 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9819 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9820 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9821
9822 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9823
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009824 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009825 a cert bundle.
9826
9827 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9828 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9829 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9830 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9831 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9832 provide multi-cert support.
9833
9834 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9835
9836 Filename | CN | SAN
9837 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9838 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009839 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009840 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9841 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9842
9843 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9844 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9845 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9846 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9847 suites.
9848
9849 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9850 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9851
9852 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9853 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9854 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9855
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009856crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9858 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009859 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009860 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009861
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009862crt-list <file>
9863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009864 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9865 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009866
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009867 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009868
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009869 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9870 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9871 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9872 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9873 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9874 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9875 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9876 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009877
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009878 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
9879 the base name is given in the crt-list. Due to the nature of bundling, all SNI
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009880 filters given to a multi-cert bundle entry are ignored.
9881
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009882defer-accept
9883 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9884 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9885 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9886 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9887 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9888 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9889 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9890 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9891 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9892 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9893 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9894
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009895force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009896 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009897 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009898 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9899 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009900
9901force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009902 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009903 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9904 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009905
9906force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009907 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009908 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9909 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009910
9911force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009912 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009913 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9914 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009915
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009916generate-certificates
9917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9918 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9919 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9920 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9921 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9922 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9923 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9924 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9925 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9926 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9927 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9928
9929 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9930 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9931 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9932 certificate is used many times.
9933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009934gid <gid>
9935 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9936 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9937 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9938 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9939 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9940
9941group <group>
9942 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9943 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9944 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9945 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9946 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9947
9948id <id>
9949 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9950 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9951 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9952 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9953
9954interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009955 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9956 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9957 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9958 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9959 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9960 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9961 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009962
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009963level <level>
9964 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9965 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9966 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9967 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9968 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9969 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9970 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9971 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9972 counters).
9973 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9974 all counters).
9975
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009976maxconn <maxconn>
9977 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9978 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9979 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9980 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9981 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9982 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9983 eat all memory.
9984
9985mode <mode>
9986 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9987 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9988 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9989 UNIX sockets.
9990
9991mss <maxseg>
9992 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9993 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9994 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9995 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9996 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9997 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9998 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9999 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10000 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10001 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10002 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10003
10004name <name>
10005 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10006 page.
10007
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010008namespace <name>
10009 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10010 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10011 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10012 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010014nice <nice>
10015 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10016 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10017 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10018 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10019 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10020 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10021 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10022 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10023 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10024 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10025 one for an RDP socket.
10026
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010027no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010029 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010030 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010031 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10032 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010033 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010034
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010035no-tls-tickets
10036 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10037 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10038 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010039 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10040 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010041
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010042no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010043 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010044 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010045 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010046 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10047 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10048 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010049
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010050no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010052 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010053 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010054 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10055 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10056 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010057
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010058no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010060 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010061 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010062 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10063 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10064 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010065
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010066npn <protocols>
10067 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10068 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10069 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10070 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010071 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10072 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010073
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010074process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10075 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10076 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10077 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10078 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10079 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10080 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10081 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010082 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10083 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10084 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10085 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10086 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10087 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10088 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010089
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010090ssl
10091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010092 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010093 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10094 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10095 to deciphered contents.
10096
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010097strict-sni
10098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10099 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10100 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10101 See the "crt" option for more information.
10102
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010103tcp-ut <delay>
10104 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10105 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10106 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10107 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10108 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10109 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10110 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10111 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10112 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10113 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10114 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10115
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010116tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010117 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010118 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10119 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10120 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10121 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10122 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10123 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10124 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010125 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10126 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10127 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010128
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010129tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10130 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10131 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10132 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10133 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10134 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10135 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10136 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10137 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10138 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10139 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010141transparent
10142 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10143 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10144 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10145 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10146 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10147 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10148 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10149 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10150 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10151 so check for support with your vendor.
10152
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010153v4v6
10154 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10155 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10156 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10157 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010158 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010159
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010160v6only
10161 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10162 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10163 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010164 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10165 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010166
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010167uid <uid>
10168 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10169 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10170 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10171 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10172 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10173
10174user <user>
10175 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10176 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10177 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10178 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10179 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10180
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010181verify [none|optional|required]
10182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10183 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10184 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10185 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10186 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010187 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10188 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10189 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10190 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200101925.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010193------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010195The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10196which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10197arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10198settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10199after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10200Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10201address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010203 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010204 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010206The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010207
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010208addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010209 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010210 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10211 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10212 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10213 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10214 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010216 Supported in default-server: No
10217
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010218agent-check
10219 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010220 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10221 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10222 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10223 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010224
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010225 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010226 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010227 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10228 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10229 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010230
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010231 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10232 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10233 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10234 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10235 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10236
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010237 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10238 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010239
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010240 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10241 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10242 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010243
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010244 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10245 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10246 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010247
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010248 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10249 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10250 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10251 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10252 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10253 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10254 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010255
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010256 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10257 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010258
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010259 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10260 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10261 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10262 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10263 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10264 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10265 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10266 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10267 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010268
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010269 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10270 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010271 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10272 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10273 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010274 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010275
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010276 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10277 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010278
10279 Supported in default-server: No
10280
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010281agent-send <string>
10282 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10283 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10284 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10285 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10286 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10287
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010288agent-inter <delay>
10289 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10290 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10291
10292 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10293 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10294 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10295 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10296 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10297 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10298 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10299 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10300 of backends use the same servers.
10301
10302 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10303
10304 Supported in default-server: Yes
10305
10306agent-port <port>
10307 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10308
10309 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10310
10311 Supported in default-server: Yes
10312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010313backup
10314 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10315 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10316 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10317 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10318 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10319 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010321 Supported in default-server: No
10322
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010323ca-file <cafile>
10324 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10325 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10326 server's certificate.
10327
10328 Supported in default-server: No
10329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010330check
10331 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010332 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10333 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10334 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10335 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10336 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10337 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10338 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010339 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10340 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10341 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010343 Supported in default-server: No
10344
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010345check-send-proxy
10346 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10347 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10348 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10349 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10350 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10351 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10352 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10353
10354 Supported in default-server: No
10355
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010356check-ssl
10357 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10358 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10359 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10360 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010361 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010362 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10363 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10364 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10365 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10366
10367 Supported in default-server: No
10368
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010369ciphers <ciphers>
10370 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010371 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010372 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10373 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10374 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10375 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10376 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10377 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10378
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010379 Supported in default-server: No
10380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010381cookie <value>
10382 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10383 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10384 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10385 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10386 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10387 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10388 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010390 Supported in default-server: No
10391
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010392crl-file <crlfile>
10393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10394 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10395 to verify server's certificate.
10396
10397 Supported in default-server: No
10398
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010399crt <cert>
10400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10401 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10402 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10403 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10404 certificate request.
10405
10406 Supported in default-server: No
10407
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010408disabled
10409 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10410 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10411 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10412 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10413 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10414
10415 Supported in default-server: No
10416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010417error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010418 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10419 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10420 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010422 Supported in default-server: Yes
10423
10424 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010425
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010426fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010427 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10428 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10429 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010431 Supported in default-server: Yes
10432
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010433force-sslv3
10434 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10435 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010436 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10437 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010438
10439 Supported in default-server: No
10440
10441force-tlsv10
10442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010443 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10444 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010445
10446 Supported in default-server: No
10447
10448force-tlsv11
10449 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010450 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10451 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010452
10453 Supported in default-server: No
10454
10455force-tlsv12
10456 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010457 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10458 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010459
10460 Supported in default-server: No
10461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010462id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010463 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10464 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10465 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010467 Supported in default-server: No
10468
10469inter <delay>
10470fastinter <delay>
10471downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010472 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10473 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10474 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10475 between checks depending on the server state :
10476
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010477 Server state | Interval used
10478 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10479 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10480 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10481 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10482 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10483 or yet unchecked. |
10484 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10485 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10486 | "inter" otherwise.
10487 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010489 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10490 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10491 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10492 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010493 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10494 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10495 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10496 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10497 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010499 Supported in default-server: Yes
10500
10501maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010502 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10503 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10504 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10505 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10506 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10507 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10508 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10509 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010511 Supported in default-server: Yes
10512
10513maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010514 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10515 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10516 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10517 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10518 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10519 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10520 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010522 Supported in default-server: Yes
10523
10524minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010525 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10526 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10527 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10528 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10529 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10530 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010531 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010532 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010534 Supported in default-server: Yes
10535
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010536namespace <name>
10537 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10538 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10539 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10540 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10541
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010542no-ssl-reuse
10543 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10544 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10545 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10546 and for paranoid users.
10547
10548 Supported in default-server: No
10549
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010550no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010551 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10552 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010553 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010554
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010555 Supported in default-server: No
10556
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010557no-tls-tickets
10558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10559 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10560 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010561 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10562 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010563
10564 Supported in default-server: No
10565
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010566no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010567 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010568 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10569 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010570 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10571 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10572 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010573
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010574 Supported in default-server: No
10575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010576no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010577 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010578 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10579 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010580 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10581 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10582 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010583
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010584 Supported in default-server: No
10585
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010586no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010587 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010588 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10589 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010590 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10591 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10592 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010593
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010594 Supported in default-server: No
10595
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010596non-stick
10597 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10598 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10599 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10600
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010601 Supported in default-server: No
10602
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010603observe <mode>
10604 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10605 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10606 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10607 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10608 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10609 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010610 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010612 Supported in default-server: No
10613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010614 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010616on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010617 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10618 Currently, four modes are available:
10619 - fastinter: force fastinter
10620 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10621 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10622 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10623 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010625 Supported in default-server: Yes
10626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010627 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10628
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010629on-marked-down <action>
10630 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10631 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010632 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10633 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10634 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10635 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10636 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10637 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10638 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10639 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010640
10641 Actions are disabled by default
10642
10643 Supported in default-server: Yes
10644
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010645on-marked-up <action>
10646 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10647 Currently one action is available:
10648 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10649 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10650 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10651 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10652 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10653 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10654 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10655 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10656
10657 Actions are disabled by default
10658
10659 Supported in default-server: Yes
10660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010661port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010662 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10663 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10664 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10665 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10666 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10667 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010669 Supported in default-server: Yes
10670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010671redir <prefix>
10672 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10673 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10674 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10675 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10676 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10677 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10678 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10679 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010680 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010681 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10682 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10683 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10684 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10685 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10686
10687 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010689 Supported in default-server: No
10690
10691rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010692 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10693 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10694 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010696 Supported in default-server: Yes
10697
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010698resolve-prefer <family>
10699 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10700 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10701 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10702 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10703
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010704 Default value: ipv6
10705
10706 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010707
10708 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10709
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010710resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10711 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10712 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10713 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10714 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10715 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10716 configured network, another address is selected.
10717
10718 Supported in default-server: Yes
10719
10720 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10721
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010722resolvers <id>
10723 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10724 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010725 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10726 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10727 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10728 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010729
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010730 Supported in default-server: No
10731
10732 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010733
10734 See also chapter 5.3
10735
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010736send-proxy
10737 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10738 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10739 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10740 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10741 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10742 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10743 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10744 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10745 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010746 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10747 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10748 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10749 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10750 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010751
10752 Supported in default-server: No
10753
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010754send-proxy-v2
10755 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10756 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10757 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10758 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10759 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10760 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10761 option of the "bind" keyword.
10762
10763 Supported in default-server: No
10764
10765send-proxy-v2-ssl
10766 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10767 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10768 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10769 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10770 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10771 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10772 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10773 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10774
10775 Supported in default-server: No
10776
10777send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10778 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10779 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10780 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10781 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10782 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10783 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10784 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10785 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10786 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10787
10788 Supported in default-server: No
10789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010790slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010791 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10792 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10793 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10794 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10795 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10796 parameters :
10797
10798 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10799 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10800
10801 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10802 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10803 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10804 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10805
10806 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10807 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10808 seen as failed.
10809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010810 Supported in default-server: Yes
10811
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010812sni <expression>
10813 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10814 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10815 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10816 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10817 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10818
10819 Supported in default-server: no
10820
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010821source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010822source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010823source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010824 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10825 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10826 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10827 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10828
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010829 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10830 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10831 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10832 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10833 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10834 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10835 server.
10836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010837 Supported in default-server: No
10838
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010839ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010840 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10841 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10842 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10843 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10844 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10845 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010846 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010847
10848 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010849
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010850tcp-ut <delay>
10851 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10852 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10853 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10854 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10855 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10856 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10857 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10858 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10859 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10860 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10861 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10862 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10863 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10864
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010865track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010866 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10867 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10868 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10869 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010870 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010872 Supported in default-server: No
10873
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010874verify [none|required]
10875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010876 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10877 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10878 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10879 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010880 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10881 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10882 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010883
10884 Supported in default-server: No
10885
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010886verifyhost <hostname>
10887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10888 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10889 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10890 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10891 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10892 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10893
10894 Supported in default-server: No
10895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010896weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010897 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10898 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10899 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010900 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10901 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10902 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10903 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10904 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10905 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010907 Supported in default-server: Yes
10908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010909
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109105.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10911-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010912
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010913HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10914using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10915configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010916This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10917can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10918workload.
10919This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10920resolution at run time.
10921Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10922carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10923
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010924Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10925health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10926
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010927
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109285.3.1. Global overview
10929----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010930
10931As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10932different steps of the process life:
10933
10934 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10935 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10936 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10937
10938 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10939 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10940 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10941
10942A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10943 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10944 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10945 resolution to know this new IP.
10946
10947A few things important to notice:
10948 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10949 first valid response.
10950
10951 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10952 servers return an error.
10953
10954
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109555.3.2. The resolvers section
10956----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010957
10958This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10959HAProxy.
10960There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10961many name servers.
10962
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010963When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10964uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10965is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10966answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10967
10968When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10969used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10970
10971Two types of behavior can be applied:
10972 1. stop DNS resolution
10973 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10974 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10975 1. ANY query type
10976 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10977 server's parameter
10978 3. remaining family type
10979
10980HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10981 - invalid DNS response packet
10982 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10983 - NX domain
10984 - Query refused by server
10985 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10986
10987HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10988 - no Answer records in the response
10989 - DNS response truncated
10990 - Error in DNS response
10991 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10992 - name server timeout
10993
10994For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10995 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10996 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10997 applied;
10998 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10999 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11000 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11001 stops resolution.
11002
11003
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011004resolvers <resolvers id>
11005 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11006
11007A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11008
11009nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11010 DNS server description:
11011 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11012 <ip> : IP address of the server
11013 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11014
11015hold <status> <period>
11016 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11017 on last resolution <status>
11018 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11019 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11020 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11021 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11022
11023 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11024
11025 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11026 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11027 the healch check.
11028
11029resolve_retries <nb>
11030 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11031 giving up.
11032 Default value: 3
11033
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011034 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11035 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11036 type.
11037
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011038timeout <event> <time>
11039 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11040 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11041 events available are:
11042 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11043 been received.
11044 Default value: 1s
11045 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11046 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11047
11048Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
11049
11050 resolvers mydns
11051 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11052 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11053 resolve_retries 3
11054 timeout retry 1s
11055 hold valid 10s
11056
11057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110586. HTTP header manipulation
11059---------------------------
11060
11061In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11062response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11063request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11064which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011065against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011066
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011067If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11068to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11069but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11070HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11071stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11072because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11073a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11074still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011076This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11077in section 4.2 :
11078
11079 - reqadd <string>
11080 - reqallow <search>
11081 - reqiallow <search>
11082 - reqdel <search>
11083 - reqidel <search>
11084 - reqdeny <search>
11085 - reqideny <search>
11086 - reqpass <search>
11087 - reqipass <search>
11088 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11089 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11090 - reqtarpit <search>
11091 - reqitarpit <search>
11092 - rspadd <string>
11093 - rspdel <search>
11094 - rspidel <search>
11095 - rspdeny <search>
11096 - rspideny <search>
11097 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11098 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11099
11100With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11101is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11102parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11103prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11104Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11105
11106 \t for a tab
11107 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11108 \n for a new line (LF)
11109 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11110 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11111 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11112 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11113 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11114
11115The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11116portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11117above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11118regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
111199 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11120is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11121
11122The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11123after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11124
11125Notes related to these keywords :
11126---------------------------------
11127 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11128 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11129 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11130
11131 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11132 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11133 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11134
11135 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11136 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11137 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11138 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11139 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11140
11141 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11142 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11143 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11144 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11145 useless headers before adding new ones.
11146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011147 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011148 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11149
11150 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11151 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11152 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11153
11154 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11155 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011156 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011157
11158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111597. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11160----------------------------------
11161
11162Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11163client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11164The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11165these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11166but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11167data called patterns.
11168
11169
111707.1. ACL basics
11171---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011172
11173The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11174content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11175from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11176simple :
11177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011179 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11181 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011183The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11184adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011185
11186In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011189
11190This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11191Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11192and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011193an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11194conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11195as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11196are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011197
11198ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11199'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11200which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11201
11202There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11203performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011205The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11206specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11207this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011208methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11209ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011210
11211Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11212 - boolean
11213 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11214 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11215 - string
11216 - data block
11217
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011218Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11219converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11220would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11221The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11222which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11223
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011224Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11225keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11226fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11227which are summarized in the table below :
11228
11229 +---------------------+-----------------+
11230 | Sample or converter | Default |
11231 | output type | matching method |
11232 +---------------------+-----------------+
11233 | boolean | bool |
11234 +---------------------+-----------------+
11235 | integer | int |
11236 +---------------------+-----------------+
11237 | ip | ip |
11238 +---------------------+-----------------+
11239 | string | str |
11240 +---------------------+-----------------+
11241 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11242 +---------------------+-----------------+
11243
11244Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11245matching method, see below.
11246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011247The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11248 - boolean
11249 - integer or integer range
11250 - IP address / network
11251 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11252 - regular expression
11253 - hex block
11254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011255The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11256
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011257 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11258 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011260 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011261 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011262 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011263 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11266read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11267if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11268lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11269will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11270beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11271a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11272lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11273exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11274
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011275The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11276parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11277ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11278a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11279check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11280
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011281The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11282socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11283file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011285Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11286loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11287
11288 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11289
11290In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11291the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11292case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11293as well.
11294
11295The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11296sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11297do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11298methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11299is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11300obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11301followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11302default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11303that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11304string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11305
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011306The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11307By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11308string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11309resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11310server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11311waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11312flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11313function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11316sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11317be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011318
11319 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11320 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011321 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11322 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11323 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11324 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011325
11326 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11327 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011329
11330 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011332
11333 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011334 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011335
11336 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11337 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11338
11339 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11340 binary or string samples.
11341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11343 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11346 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11347 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011349 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11350 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11353 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11356 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11359 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011360 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11363 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11364 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011365
11366For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11367request, it is possible to do :
11368
11369 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11370
11371In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11372buffer, one would use the following acl :
11373
11374 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11375
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011376On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11377possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11378
11379 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11382criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11383method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11384to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11385criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11386the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011389the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11390For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011392 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11393 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11394 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11395 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011396
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011397
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011398The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11399types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11400combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11401brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11402default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011404 +-------------------------------------------------+
11405 | Input sample type |
11406 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011407 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11409 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11410 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011411 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011412 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011413 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011415 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011417 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011418 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011419 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011421 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011423 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011424 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011425 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011427 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011428 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011429 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011430 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011431 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011432 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11433 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11434 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011435
11436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114377.1.1. Matching booleans
11438------------------------
11439
11440In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11441Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11442When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11443that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11444
11445Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11446return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11447"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114507.1.2. Matching integers
11451------------------------
11452
11453Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11454enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11455to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11456
11457Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11458matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11459lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011460
11461For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11462unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11463representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11464
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011465As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11466two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11467instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11468ranges and operators.
11469
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011470For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011471operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11472Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11473of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011475Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011476
11477 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11478 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11479 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11480 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11481 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11482
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011483For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011484
11485 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11486
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011487This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11488
11489 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114927.1.3. Matching strings
11493-----------------------
11494
11495String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11496different forms :
11497
11498 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11499 patterns ;
11500
11501 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11502 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11503
11504 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11505 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11506
11507 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11508 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11509
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011510 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11512 matches.
11513
11514 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11515 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11516 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011517
11518String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11519exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11520characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11521string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11522to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011523before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011524
11525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115267.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11527---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011528
11529Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11530they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11531possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11532passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11533the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011534the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11535match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011536
11537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115387.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11539-------------------------------------
11540
11541It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11542not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11543a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11544to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11545digits may be used upper or lower case.
11546
11547Example :
11548 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11549 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11550
11551
115527.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11553---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011554
11555IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11556netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11557within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011558host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011559difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11560at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11561does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11562parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011563
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011564The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11565abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11566
11567 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11568 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11569 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11570 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11571 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11572 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11573 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11574 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11575
11576Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11577192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11578
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011579IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11580Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11581trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11582IPv6 patterns.
11583
11584HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11585following situations :
11586 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11587 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11588 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11589 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11590 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11591 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11592 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11593 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11594 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11595 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011597
115987.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11599----------------------------------
11600
11601Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11602combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11603
11604 - AND (implicit)
11605 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11606 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011608A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011610 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011612Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11613indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011615For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11616"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11617requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11618is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11619
11620 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11621 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11622 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11623 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11624
11625To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11626and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11627
11628 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11629 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11630 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11631 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11632
11633 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11634 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11635 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11636 use_backend www if host_www
11637
11638It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11639expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11640be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11641the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11642
11643 The following rule :
11644
11645 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11646 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11647
11648 Can also be written that way :
11649
11650 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11651
11652It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11653to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11654simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11655sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11656good use is the following :
11657
11658 With named ACLs :
11659
11660 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11661 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11662 monitor fail if site_dead
11663
11664 With anonymous ACLs :
11665
11666 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11667
11668See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11669
11670
116717.3. Fetching samples
11672---------------------
11673
11674Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11675against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11676sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11677ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11678of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11679available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11680
11681This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11682Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11683compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11684deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11685
11686The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11687matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11688method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11689indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11690
11691As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11692when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11693mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11694the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11695ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11696
11697Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11698multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11699when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11700incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11701are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11702is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11703all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11704
11705Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11706 - name
11707 - name(arg1)
11708 - name(arg1,arg2)
11709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011710
117117.3.1. Converters
11712-----------------
11713
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011714Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11715of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11716is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11717was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11718has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11719unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11720
11721These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11722sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11723the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11724support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011725
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011726A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11727support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11728supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11729(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11730bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011732The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011733
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011734add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011735 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011736 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011737 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11738 scopes allowed are:
11739 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11740 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011744 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011745
11746and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011747 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011748 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011749 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11750 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11753 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11754 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11755 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011756 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011757
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011758base64
11759 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11760 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11761 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11762
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011763bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011764 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011765 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11766 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11767 presence of a flag).
11768
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011769bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11770 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11771 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11772 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11773
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011774cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011775 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11776 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011777
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011778crc32([<avalanche>])
11779 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11780 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11781 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11782 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11783 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11784 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11785 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11786 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11787 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11788 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11789 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11790
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011791da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011792 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11793 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11794 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11795 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011796 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011797 configuration language.
11798
11799 Example:
11800 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011801 bind *:8881
11802 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011803 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011804
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011805debug
11806 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11807 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11808 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11809
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011810div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011811 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11812 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011813 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011814 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11815 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11818 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11820 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011821 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011822
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011823djb2([<avalanche>])
11824 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11825 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11826 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11827 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11828 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11829 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11830 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011831 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11832 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011833
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011834even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011835 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011836 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11837
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011838field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11839 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11840 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11841 list of chars.
11842
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011843hex
11844 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11845 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11846 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11847 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011848
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011849http_date([<offset>])
11850 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11851 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11852 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11853 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11854 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11855 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011857in_table(<table>)
11858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11860 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11861 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11862 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11863
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011864ipmask(<mask>)
11865 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11866 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11867 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11868 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11869
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011870json([<input-code>])
11871 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11872 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11873 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11874 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11875 of errors:
11876 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11877 bytes, ...)
11878 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11879 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11880
11881 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11882 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11883 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11884 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11885 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11886 are :
11887 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11888 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11889 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11890 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11891 error ;
11892 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11893 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11894
11895 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11896 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11897
11898 Example:
11899 capture request header user-agent len 150
11900 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011901 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011902
11903 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11904 GET / HTTP/1.0
11905 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11906
11907 Output log:
11908 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11909
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011910language(<value>[,<default>])
11911 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11912 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11913 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11914 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11915 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11916 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11917 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11918 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11919 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11920 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11921 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11922 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011923
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011924 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011925
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011926 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11927 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011928
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011929 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11930 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11931 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11932 use_backend spanish if es
11933 use_backend french if fr
11934 use_backend english if en
11935 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011936
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011937lower
11938 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11939 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11940 type. The result is of type string.
11941
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011942ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11943 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11944 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11945 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11946 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11947 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11948 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11949
11950 Example :
11951
11952 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11953 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11954 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11955
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011956map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11957map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11958map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11959 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11960 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11961 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11962 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11963 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11964 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11965 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11966 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011968 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11969 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11970 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011972 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11973 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011974
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011975 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11976 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11977 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11978 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011979 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11980 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011981 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11982 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11983 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11984 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11985 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11986 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11987 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11988 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011989 | | map_reg | |
11990 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11991 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011992 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11993 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11994 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11995 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11996 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011997
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011998 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
11999 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12000 the corresponding match text.
12001
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012002 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12003 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12004 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12005 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12006 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012008 Example :
12009
12010 # this is a comment and is ignored
12011 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12012 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12013 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12014 | | | `---------- value
12015 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12016 | `---------------------------- key
12017 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12018
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012019mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012020 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12021 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012022 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012023 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12024 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12025 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012029 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012030
12031mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012032 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012033 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12034 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012035 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012036 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12037 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12038 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12039 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12040 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12041 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012042 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012043
12044neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012045 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12046 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12047 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12048 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012049
12050not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012051 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012052 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12053 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12054 absence of a flag).
12055
12056odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012057 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012058 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12059
12060or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012061 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012062 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012063 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12064 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012071
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012072regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012073 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12074 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12075 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12076 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12077 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12078 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12079 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12080 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12081 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12082 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012083 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12084 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12085 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12086 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012087
12088 Example :
12089
12090 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12091 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12092 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12093 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12094
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012095capture-req(<id>)
12096 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12097 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12098
12099 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012100 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12101 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012102
12103capture-res(<id>)
12104 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12105 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12106
12107 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012108 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12109 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012110
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012111sdbm([<avalanche>])
12112 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12113 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12114 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12115 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12116 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12117 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12118 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012119 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12120 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012121
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012122set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012123 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12124 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12125 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12126 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12127 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012128 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012129 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12130 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012131 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12132 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12133
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012134sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012135 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12136 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012137 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012138 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12139 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12140 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12141 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012142 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012143 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12144 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012145 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12146 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012147
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012148table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12149 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12150 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12151 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12152 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12153 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12154 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12155
12156
12157table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12158 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12159 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12160 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12161 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12162 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12163 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12164
12165table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12166 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12167 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12168 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12169 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12170 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12171
12172table_conn_cur(<table>)
12173 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12174 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12175 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12176 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12177 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12178
12179table_conn_rate(<table>)
12180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12183 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12184 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12185
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012186table_gpt0(<table>)
12187 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12188 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12189 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12190 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12191 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12192
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012193table_gpc0(<table>)
12194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12197 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12198 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12199
12200table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12203 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12204 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12205 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12206 sample fetch keyword.
12207
12208table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12212 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12213 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12214
12215table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12216 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12217 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12218 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12219 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12220 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12221 keyword.
12222
12223table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12227 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12228 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12229
12230table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12233 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12234 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12235 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12236 keyword.
12237
12238table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12239 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12240 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12241 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12242 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12243 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12244 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12245 keyword.
12246
12247table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12248 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12249 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12250 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12251 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12252 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12253 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12254 keyword.
12255
12256table_server_id(<table>)
12257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12260 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12261 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12262 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12263
12264table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12265 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12266 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12267 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12268 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12269 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12270 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12271 keyword.
12272
12273table_sess_rate(<table>)
12274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12276 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12277 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12278 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12279 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12280 keyword.
12281
12282table_trackers(<table>)
12283 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12284 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12285 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12286 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12287 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12288 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12289 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12290 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12291 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12292 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12293
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012294upper
12295 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12296 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12297 type. The result is of type string.
12298
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012299url_dec
12300 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12301 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12302
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012303utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12304 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12305 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12306 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12307 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12308 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12309 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12310
12311 Example :
12312
12313 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12314 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12315 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12316
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012317word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12318 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12319 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12320
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012321wt6([<avalanche>])
12322 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12323 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12324 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12325 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12326 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12327 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12328 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012329 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12330 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012331
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012332xor(<value>)
12333 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012334 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012335 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012336 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012339 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12343 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012344
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012345
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123467.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347--------------------------------------------
12348
12349A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12350not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12351"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12352The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12353
12354always_false : boolean
12355 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12356 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12357
12358always_true : boolean
12359 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12360 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12361
12362avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012363 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012364 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12365 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12366 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12367 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12368 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12369 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12370 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12371 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12372 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12373 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12374 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12375 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12376 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012378be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012379 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12380 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12381 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12382 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12383 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012385be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12386 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12387 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12388 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12389 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12390 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12391 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012392
12393 Example :
12394 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12395 backend dynamic
12396 mode http
12397 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12398 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012399
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012400bin(<hexa>) : bin
12401 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12402 of the string.
12403
12404bool(<bool>) : bool
12405 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12406 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012408connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012410 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012411 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12412 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012413
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012414 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012415 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012416 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12417
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012418 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12419 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012420
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012421 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012422 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012424 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12425 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012426 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012427 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012428
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012429 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12430 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012432 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012433
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012434date([<offset>]) : integer
12435 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12436 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12437 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12438 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012439 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12440
12441 Example :
12442
12443 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12444 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012445
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012446env(<name>) : string
12447 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12448 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12449 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12450 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12451 certain way.
12452
12453 Examples :
12454 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12455 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12456
12457 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12458 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12461 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012462 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12463 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012464 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12465 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12466 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12467 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12468 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12471 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12472 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12473 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12474 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12475 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12476 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12477 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12478 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012479
12480 Example :
12481 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12482 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12483 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12484 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12485 frontend mail
12486 bind :25
12487 mode tcp
12488 maxconn 100
12489 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12490 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12491 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12492 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012493
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012494int(<integer>) : signed integer
12495 Returns a signed integer.
12496
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012497ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12498 Returns an ipv4.
12499
12500ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12501 Returns an ipv6.
12502
12503meth(<method>) : method
12504 Returns a method.
12505
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012506nbproc : integer
12507 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12508 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12509 and debugging purposes.
12510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012511nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12512 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12513 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12514 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012515 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12516 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12517 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012518
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012519proc : integer
12520 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12521 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12522 debugging purposes.
12523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012524queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012525 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12526 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12527 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12529 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12530 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12531 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12532 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12533
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012534rand([<range>]) : integer
12535 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12536 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12537 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12538 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12539 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012541srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12543 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12544 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12545 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12546 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12547 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12548 methods.
12549
12550srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12551 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12552 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12553 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12554 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12555 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12556 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12557 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12558
12559srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12560 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12561 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012562 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12564 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12565 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12566 overloading servers).
12567
12568 Example :
12569 # Redirect to a separate back
12570 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12571 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12572 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12573
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012574stopping : boolean
12575 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12576 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12577 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12578
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012579str(<string>) : string
12580 Returns a string.
12581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12583 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12585
12586table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12587 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12588 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12589 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12590
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012591var(<var-name>) : undefined
12592 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012593 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12594 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12595 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12596 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012597 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012598 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12599 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012600 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12601 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12602
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126037.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012604----------------------------------
12605
12606The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12607closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12608methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12609sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12610TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012611the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12612counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12613"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012614argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12615the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12616this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617
12618be_id : integer
12619 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12620 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12621
12622dst : ip
12623 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12624 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12625 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12626 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12627 RFC 4291.
12628
12629dst_conn : integer
12630 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12631 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12632 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12633 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12634 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12635 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12636 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12637 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012639dst_port : integer
12640 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12641 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12642 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12643 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12644 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12645 an HTTP header.
12646
12647fe_id : integer
12648 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12649 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12650 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12651
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012652sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012653sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12654sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12655sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012656 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12657 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12658 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12659
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012660sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012661sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12662sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12663sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012664 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12665 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12666 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012668sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012669sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12670sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12671sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012672 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12673 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012674 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12675 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12676 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012677
12678 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12679 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012680 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12681 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12682 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012683 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12684 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12685
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012686sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012687sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12688sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12689sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012690 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12691 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12692
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012693sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012694sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12695sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12696sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012697 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12698 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12699 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012701sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012702sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12703sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12704sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012705 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12706 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12707 See also src_conn_rate.
12708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012709sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012710sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12711sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12712sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012713 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012714 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012715
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012716sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12717sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12718sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12719sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12720 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12721 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12722
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012723sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012724sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12725sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12726sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012727 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12728 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12729 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012730 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12731 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12732 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012734sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012735sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12736sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12737sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012738 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12739 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12740 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12741
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012742sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012743sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12744sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12745sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012746 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12747 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12748 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12749 src_http_err_rate.
12750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012751sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012752sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12753sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12754sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012755 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12756 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12757 src_http_req_cnt.
12758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012759sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012760sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12761sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12762sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012763 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12764 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12765 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12766 src_http_req_rate.
12767
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012768sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012769sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12770sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12771sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012772 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012773 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12774 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12775 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12776 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012777
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012778 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12779 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012780 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12781
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012782sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012783sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12784sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12785sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012786 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12787 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12788 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012790sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012791sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12792sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12793sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012794 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12795 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12796 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012798sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012799sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12800sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12801sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012802 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12803 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12804 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12805 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012806 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012807 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012809sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012810sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12811sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12812sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012813 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12814 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12815 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12816 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12817 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012818 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012820sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012821sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12822sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12823sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012824 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12825 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12826 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012828sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012829sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12830sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12831sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012832 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12833 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012834 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012835 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12836 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12838 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12839 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012841so_id : integer
12842 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12843 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12844 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846src : ip
12847 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12848 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12849 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12850 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12851 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12852 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12853 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012854
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012855 Example:
12856 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12857 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12860 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12861 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12862 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012863 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12866 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12867 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012868 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012869 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12872 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12873 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12874 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12875 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12876 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12877 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012878
12879 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12880 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12881 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12882 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012883 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012884 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12885 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012887src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012888 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012890 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012891 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012894 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12896 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012897 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12900 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12901 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12902 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012903 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012905src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012906 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012908 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012909 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012910
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012911src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12912 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12913 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12914 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12915 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012918 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012920 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12921 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012922 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12923 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12924 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12927 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12928 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012929 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012930 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012931 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12934 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12935 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12936 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12937 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012938 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12941 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12942 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12943 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012944 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12947 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12948 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12949 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012950 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012951 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12954 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12955 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12956 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012957 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12959 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012960
12961 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012962 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012963 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012966 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12967 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12968 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12969 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12970 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012973 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12974 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12975 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12976 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12977 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012979src_port : integer
12980 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12981 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12982 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12983 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12986 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012987 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12988 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12989 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012990 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12993 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12994 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12995 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12996 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012997 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13000 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13001 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13002 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13003 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13004 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13005 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13006 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13007 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013008
13009 Example :
13010 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13011 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13012 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13013 listen ssh
13014 bind :22
13015 mode tcp
13016 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013017 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013018 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013019 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021srv_id : integer
13022 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13023 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13024 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013025
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010013026
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130277.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013028----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13031closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13032when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13033usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013034future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013035
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013036ssl_bc : boolean
13037 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13038 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13039 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13040
13041ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13042 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13044
13045ssl_bc_cipher : string
13046 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13047 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13048
13049ssl_bc_protocol : string
13050 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13051 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13052
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013053ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013054 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013055 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13056 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013057
13058ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13059 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13060 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13061 if session was reused or not.
13062
13063ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13064 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13065 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13068 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13069 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13070 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13071 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13072 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13075 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13076 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13077 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13078 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013079
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013080ssl_c_der : binary
13081 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13082 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13083 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085ssl_c_err : integer
13086 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13087 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13088 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13089 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13090 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13093 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13094 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13095 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13096 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13097 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13098 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13099 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13100 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102ssl_c_key_alg : string
13103 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13104 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13105 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013107ssl_c_notafter : string
13108 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13109 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13110 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112ssl_c_notbefore : string
13113 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13114 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13115 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13118 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13119 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13120 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13121 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13122 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13123 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13124 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13125 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013127ssl_c_serial : binary
13128 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13129 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13130 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13133 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13134 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13135 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013136 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13137 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13138
13139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13142 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13143 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13144 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146ssl_c_used : boolean
13147 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13148 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150ssl_c_verify : integer
13151 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13152 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13153 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13154 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156ssl_c_version : integer
13157 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13158 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013159
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013160ssl_f_der : binary
13161 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13162 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13163 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13166 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13167 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13168 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13169 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013170 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13172 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13173 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175ssl_f_key_alg : string
13176 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13177 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13178 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180ssl_f_notafter : string
13181 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13182 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13183 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185ssl_f_notbefore : string
13186 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13187 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13188 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013190ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13191 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13192 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13193 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13194 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13195 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13196 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13197 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13198 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200ssl_f_serial : binary
13201 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13203 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013204
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013205ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13206 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13207 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13208 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13211 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13212 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13213 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215ssl_f_version : integer
13216 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13217 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13218
13219ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013220 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13221 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13222 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013224 Example :
13225 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13226 listen http-https
13227 bind :80
13228 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13229 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13230
13231ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13232 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13233 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13234
13235ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013236 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13238 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13239 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13240 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13241 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13242 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13243 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13244 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246ssl_fc_cipher : string
13247 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13248 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013251 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13252 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013253 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13254 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13255 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13256 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13259 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013260 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13261 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13262 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13263 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013264
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013265ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013266 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13267 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013270 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13272 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13273 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13274 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13275 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13276 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13277 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279ssl_fc_protocol : string
13280 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13281 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013282
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013283ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013284 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013285 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13286 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13289 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13290 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13291 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13292 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294ssl_fc_sni : string
13295 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13296 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13297 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13298 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13299 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13300
13301 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13302 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13303 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013304 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13305 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13309 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013311ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13312 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13313 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013314
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013315
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13320sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13321only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13322For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13323be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13324can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13325sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13326for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13327content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013329payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13330 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13331 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13332 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13335 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13336 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13337 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013339req.len : integer
13340req_len : integer (deprecated)
13341 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13342 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13343 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13344 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13345 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13346 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13347 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13348 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13351 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013352 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13353 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13354 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13355 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357 ACL alternatives :
13358 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13361 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13362 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13363 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13364 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366 ACL alternatives :
13367 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371req.proto_http : boolean
13372req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13373 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13374 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13375 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13376 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13377 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13378 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13379 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381 Example:
13382 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13383 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13384 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013385 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013387req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13388rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13389 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13390 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13391 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13392 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13393 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13394 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13395 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013397 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13398 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13399 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13400 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13401 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13402 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013404 ACL derivatives :
13405 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407 Example :
13408 listen tse-farm
13409 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13410 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13411 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13412 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13413 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13414 persist rdp-cookie
13415 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13416 # This is only useful makes sense if
13417 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13418 stick-table type string size 204800
13419 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13420 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13421 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13424 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13427rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13428 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13429 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13430 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13431 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 ACL derivatives :
13434 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013435
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013436req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13437 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13438 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013439 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13440 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13441 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13442 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13443 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13446req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13447 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13448 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13449 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13450 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13451 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13452 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13453 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455req.ssl_sni : string
13456req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13457 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13458 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13459 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13460 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13461 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13462 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13463 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13464 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13465 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13466 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13467 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13468 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470 ACL derivatives :
13471 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 Examples :
13474 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13475 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13476 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13477 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13478 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013479
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013480req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13481 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13482 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13483 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13484 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13485 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13486 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13487 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13488 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13489 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491req.ssl_ver : integer
13492req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13493 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13494 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13495 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13496 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13497 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13498 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13499 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13500 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13501 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503 ACL derivatives :
13504 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013505
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013506res.len : integer
13507 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13508 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13509 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13510 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13511 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13512 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13513 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13514 content inspection.
13515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013516res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13517 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013518 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13519 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13520 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13521 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13524 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13525 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13526 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13527 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013530
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013531res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13532rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13533 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13534 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13535 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13536 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13537 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13538 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13539 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541wait_end : boolean
13542 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13543 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13544 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13545 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13546 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13547 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13548 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13549 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013551 Examples :
13552 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13553 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13554 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013556 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13557 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13558 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13559 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13560 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13561 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13562 tcp-request content reject
13563
13564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135657.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013566--------------------------------------
13567
13568It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13569This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13570data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13571its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13572HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13573content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13574to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13575more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13576response are indexed.
13577
13578base : string
13579 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13580 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13581 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13582 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13583 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13584 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13585 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13586 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13587
13588 ACL derivatives :
13589 base : exact string match
13590 base_beg : prefix match
13591 base_dir : subdir match
13592 base_dom : domain match
13593 base_end : suffix match
13594 base_len : length match
13595 base_reg : regex match
13596 base_sub : substring match
13597
13598base32 : integer
13599 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13600 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13601 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013602 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13603 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13604 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605
13606base32+src : binary
13607 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13608 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13609 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13610 per-URL counters.
13611
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013612capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13613 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13614 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13615 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13616
13617capture.req.method : string
13618 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13619 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13620 because it's allocated.
13621
13622capture.req.uri : string
13623 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13624 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13625 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13626 allocated.
13627
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013628capture.req.ver : string
13629 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13630 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13631 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13632
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013633capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13634 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13635 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13636 The first entry is an index of 0.
13637 See also: "capture response header"
13638
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013639capture.res.ver : string
13640 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13641 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13642 persistent flag.
13643
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013644req.body : binary
13645 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13646 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13647 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13648 the first chunk is analyzed.
13649
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013650req.body_param([<name>) : string
13651 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13652 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13653 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13654 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13655 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13656 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13657 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13658 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13659 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13660 given.
13661
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013662req.body_len : integer
13663 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13664 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13665 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13666 "option http-buffer-request".
13667
13668req.body_size : integer
13669 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13670 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13671 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13672 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13673 "option http-buffer-request".
13674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675req.cook([<name>]) : string
13676cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13677 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13678 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13679 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13680 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13681 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13682 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13683 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13684 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13685
13686 ACL derivatives :
13687 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13688 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13689 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13690 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13691 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13692 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13693 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13694 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013696req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13697cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13698 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13699 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013701req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13702cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13703 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13704 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13705 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13706 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13709 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13710 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13711 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13712 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013713 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13715 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13716 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13717 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13720 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13721 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13722 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13723 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013724 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013726req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13727 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13728 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13729 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13730 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13731 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13732 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13733 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13734 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013736req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13737 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13738 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13739 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13740 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13743 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13744 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13745 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13746 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13747 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13748 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13749 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13750 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13751 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13752 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13753 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 ACL derivatives :
13756 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13757 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13758 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13759 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13760 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13761 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13762 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13763 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13764
13765req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13766hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13767 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13768 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13769 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13770 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13771 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13772 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13773 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13774 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13775 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13776
13777req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13778hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13779 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13780 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13781 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13782 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13783 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13784 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13785 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13786 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13787
13788req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13789hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13790 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13791 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13792 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13793 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13794 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13795 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13796 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13797
13798http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13799 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13800 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13801 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13802 basic auth is supported.
13803
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013804http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13805 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13806 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13807 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13808 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013809 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13810 basic auth is supported.
13811
13812 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013813 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13814 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13815 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13816 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817
13818http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013819 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13820 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13822 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824method : integer + string
13825 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13826 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13827 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13828 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13829 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13830 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13831 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013833 ACL derivatives :
13834 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836 Example :
13837 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13838 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13839 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841path : string
13842 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13843 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13844 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13845 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13846 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13847 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13848 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013850 ACL derivatives :
13851 path : exact string match
13852 path_beg : prefix match
13853 path_dir : subdir match
13854 path_dom : domain match
13855 path_end : suffix match
13856 path_len : length match
13857 path_reg : regex match
13858 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013859
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013860query : string
13861 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13862 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13863 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13864 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13865 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13866 which stops before the question mark.
13867
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013868req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13869 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13870 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13871 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13872 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874req.ver : string
13875req_ver : string (deprecated)
13876 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13877 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13878 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880 ACL derivatives :
13881 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013883res.comp : boolean
13884 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13885 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13886 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888res.comp_algo : string
13889 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13890 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13891 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013893res.cook([<name>]) : string
13894scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13895 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13896 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13897 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899 ACL derivatives :
13900 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13903scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13904 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13905 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13906 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013908res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13909scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13910 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13911 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13912 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13915 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13916 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13917 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13918 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13919 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13920 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13921 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13922 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13923 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013925res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13926 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13927 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13928 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13929 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13930 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13933shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13934 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13935 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13936 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13937 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13938 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13939 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13940 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13941 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943 ACL derivatives :
13944 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13945 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13946 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13947 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13948 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13949 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13950 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13951 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13952
13953res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13954shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13955 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13956 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13957 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13958 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13959 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13962shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13963 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13964 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13965 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13966 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13967 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13968 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013969
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013970res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13971 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13972 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13973 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13974 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013976res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13977shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13978 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13979 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13980 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13981 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13982 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13983 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013985res.ver : string
13986resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13987 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13988 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013990 ACL derivatives :
13991 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13995 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013996 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013997 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14000 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002status : integer
14003 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14004 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14005 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014006
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014007unique-id : string
14008 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14009 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14010 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14011 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14012 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14013 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015url : string
14016 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14017 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14018 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14019 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14020 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14021 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14022 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014024 ACL derivatives :
14025 url : exact string match
14026 url_beg : prefix match
14027 url_dir : subdir match
14028 url_dom : domain match
14029 url_end : suffix match
14030 url_len : length match
14031 url_reg : regex match
14032 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034url_ip : ip
14035 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14036 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14037 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14038 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14039 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14040 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14041 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043url_port : integer
14044 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14045 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14046 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14047 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014048
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014049urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14050url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14052 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014053 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14054 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14055 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14056 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014057 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14058 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014059 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14060 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062 ACL derivatives :
14063 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14064 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14065 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14066 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14067 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14068 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14069 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14070 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014071
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014073 Example :
14074 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14075 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14076 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14077 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014078
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014079urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014080 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14081 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14082 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014083
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014086---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014088Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14089every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014090order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014092ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14093---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014094FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014095HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014096HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14097HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014098HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14099HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14100HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14101HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14102LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014103METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014104METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014105METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14106METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14107METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14108METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014109METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014111RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014112REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014113TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014114WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14115---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014116
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141188. Logging
14119----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014120
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014121One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14122provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14123very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14124provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14125state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014126to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014127headers.
14128
14129In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14130about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14131send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14132
14133 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14134 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14135 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14136 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14137 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014138 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14139 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014140
14141The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14142allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14143as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14144while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14145real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14146delay.
14147
14148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141498.1. Log levels
14150---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014151
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014152TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014153source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014154HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14155in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14156track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14157syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14158about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014159
14160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141618.2. Log formats
14162----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014163
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014164HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014165and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14166slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14167options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014168
14169 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14170 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14171 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14172 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14173 extents.
14174
14175 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14176 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14177 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14178 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14179 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14180
14181 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14182 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14183 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14184 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14185 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14186
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014187 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14188 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14189 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14190 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14191
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014192 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14193
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014194Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14195specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14196field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14197servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14198always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14199identifier.
14200
14201Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14202 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14203 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14204 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14205 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14206
14207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142088.2.1. Default log format
14209-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014210
14211This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14212as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14213format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14214
14215 Example :
14216 listen www
14217 mode http
14218 log global
14219 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14220
14221 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14222 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14223 (www/HTTP)
14224
14225 Field Format Extract from the example above
14226 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14227 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14228 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14229 4 'to' to
14230 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14231 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14232
14233Detailed fields description :
14234 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14235 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14236 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14237 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14238 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14239 and processed the connection.
14240 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14241
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014242In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14243"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14244connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14245
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014246It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14247will eventually disappear.
14248
14249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142508.2.2. TCP log format
14251---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014252
14253The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14254is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14255information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14256counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14257emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14258environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14259the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14260sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014261specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14262not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14263fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14264marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014265
14266 Example :
14267 frontend fnt
14268 mode tcp
14269 option tcplog
14270 log global
14271 default_backend bck
14272
14273 backend bck
14274 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14275
14276 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14277 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14278 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14279
14280 Field Format Extract from the example above
14281 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14282 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14283 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14284 4 frontend_name fnt
14285 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14286 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14287 7 bytes_read* 212
14288 8 termination_state --
14289 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14290 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14291
14292Detailed fields description :
14293 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014294 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14295 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14296 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14297 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14298 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014299
14300 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014301 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14302 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14303 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014304
14305 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14306 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14307 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14308 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14309
14310 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14311 and processed the connection.
14312
14313 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14314 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14315 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14316 applications.
14317
14318 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14319 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14320 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14321 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14322 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14323
14324 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14325 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14326 See "Timers" below for more details.
14327
14328 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14329 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14330 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14331 "Timers" below for more details.
14332
14333 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014334 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014335 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14336 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14337 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14338 details.
14339
14340 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14341 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14342 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14343 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14344 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14345
14346 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14347 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14348 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14349 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14350 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14351 for more details.
14352
14353 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014354 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014355 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14356 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14357 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014358 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014359
14360 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14361 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14362 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14363 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14364 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14365 caused by a denial of service attack.
14366
14367 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14368 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14369 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14370 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14371 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14372 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14373 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14374 denial of service attack.
14375
14376 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14377 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14378 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14379 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14380 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14381 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14382 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14383 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14384 be processed than on other servers.
14385
14386 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14387 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14388 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14389 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14390 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14391 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14392 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14393 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14394 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14395 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14396 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14397 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14398 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14399
14400 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14401 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14402 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14403 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14404 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14405 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14406 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14407 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14408
14409 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14410 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14411 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14412 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14413 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14414 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14415 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14416 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14417 occurs.
14418
14419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144208.2.3. HTTP log format
14421----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014422
14423The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14424is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14425the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14426are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14427emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14428generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14429"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14430which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014431frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14432is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014433
14434Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14435slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14436with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14437
14438 Example :
14439 frontend http-in
14440 mode http
14441 option httplog
14442 log global
14443 default_backend bck
14444
14445 backend static
14446 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14447
14448 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14449 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14450 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014451 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014452
14453 Field Format Extract from the example above
14454 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14455 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14456 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14457 4 frontend_name http-in
14458 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14459 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14460 7 status_code 200
14461 8 bytes_read* 2750
14462 9 captured_request_cookie -
14463 10 captured_response_cookie -
14464 11 termination_state ----
14465 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14466 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14467 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14468 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14469 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014471
14472Detailed fields description :
14473 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014474 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14475 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14476 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14477 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14478 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014479
14480 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014481 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14482 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14483 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014484
14485 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14486 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14487 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14488 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14489 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14490
14491 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14492 and processed the connection.
14493
14494 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14495 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14496 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14497
14498 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14499 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14500 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14501 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14502 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14503 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14504
14505 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14506 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14507 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14508 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14509 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14510 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14511
14512 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14513 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14514 See "Timers" below for more details.
14515
14516 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14517 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14518 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14519 below for more details.
14520
14521 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14522 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14523 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14524 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14525 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14526 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14527 for more details.
14528
14529 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014530 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014531 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14532 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14533 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14534 details.
14535
14536 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14537 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14538 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14539
14540 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14541 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14542 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14543 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14544 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14545 overflowing.
14546
14547 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14548 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14549 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14550 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14551 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14552 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14553 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14554 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14555
14556 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14557 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14558 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14559 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14560 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14561 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14562 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14563 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14564
14565 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14566 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14567 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14568 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14569 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14570 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14571 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14572
14573 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014574 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014575 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14576 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14577 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014578 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014579 system.
14580
14581 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14582 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14583 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14584 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14585 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14586 caused by a denial of service attack.
14587
14588 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14589 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14590 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14591 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14592 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14593 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14594 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14595 denial of service attack.
14596
14597 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14598 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14599 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14600 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14601 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14602 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14603 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14604 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14605 processed than on other servers.
14606
14607 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14608 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14609 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14610 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14611 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14612 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14613 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14614 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14615 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14616 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14617 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14618 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14619 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14620
14621 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14622 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14623 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14624 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14625 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14626 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14627 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14628 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14629
14630 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14631 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14632 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14633 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14634 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14635 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14636 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14637 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14638 occurs.
14639
14640 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14641 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14642 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14643 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14644 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14645 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14646 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14647 cookies" below for more details.
14648
14649 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14650 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14651 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14652 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14653 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14654 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14655 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14656 and cookies" below for more details.
14657
14658 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14659 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14660 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14661 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14662 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14663 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14664 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14665 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14666
14667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200146688.2.4. Custom log format
14669------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014670
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014671The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014672mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014673
14674HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14675Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14676separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14677prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14678
14679Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14680variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014681("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014682
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014683If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014684as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014685less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14686the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14687
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014688Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014689In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014690in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014691
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014692Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14693'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14694https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14695such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14696
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014697Flags are :
14698 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014699 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014700 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14701 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014702
14703 Example:
14704
14705 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14706 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14707
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014708 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14709
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014710At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14711
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014712 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14713 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014714
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014715the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014716
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014717 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014718 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014719 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014720
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014721and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14722
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014723 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014724 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014726Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14727
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014728 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014729 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014730 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14731 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14732 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014733 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14734 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14735 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014736 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014737 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14738 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014739 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014740 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14741 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014742 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014743 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014744 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014745 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014746 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014747 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014748 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14749 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014750 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014751 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14752 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014753 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014754 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14755 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014756 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14757 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14758 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014759 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014760 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14761 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014762 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014763 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14764 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14765 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014766 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014767 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014768 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14769 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14770 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14771 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014772 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014773 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014774 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014775 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014776 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014777 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014778 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14779 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14780 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014781 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014782 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14783 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014784 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014785 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014786 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014787 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014788
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014789 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014790
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014791
147928.2.5. Error log format
14793-----------------------
14794
14795When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14796protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14797By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14798"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14799will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14800logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14801
14802The format looks like this :
14803
14804 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14805 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14806 Connection error during SSL handshake
14807
14808 Field Format Extract from the example above
14809 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14810 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14811 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14812 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14813 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14814
14815These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14816failures.
14817
14818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148198.3. Advanced logging options
14820-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014821
14822Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14823just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14824options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14825for more information about their usage.
14826
14827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14829------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014830
14831It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14832haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14833commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14834monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14835ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14836
14837 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14838 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14839 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14840 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14841
14842 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14843 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14844 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014845 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014846 such as other load-balancers.
14847
14848 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14849 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14850 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14851
14852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14854----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014855
14856The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14857what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14858or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14859"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14860just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14861log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14862after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14863is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14864with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14865with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14866
14867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14869------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014870
14871Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14872for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14873"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14874retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14875raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14876a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14877file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14878you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14879"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14880
14881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14883--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014884
14885Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14886multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14887them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14888"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14889logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14890error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14891and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14892too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14893useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14894alternative.
14895
14896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148978.4. Timing events
14898------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014899
14900Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14901reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14902the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14903frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14904mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14905
14906 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14907 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14908 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14909 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14910 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14911
14912 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14913 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14914 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14915 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14916 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14917
14918 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14919 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14920 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14921 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14922 connection never established.
14923
14924 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14925 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14926 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14927 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14928 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14929 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14930 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14931 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14932 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14933 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14934 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14935
14936 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14937 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14938 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14939 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014940 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014941
14942 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14943
14944 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14945 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14946 negative.
14947
14948These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14949protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14950that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014951due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014952close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14953session has been aborted on timeout.
14954
14955Most common cases :
14956
14957 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14958 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14959 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14960 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14961 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14962 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14963 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14964 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14965 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010014966 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014967 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14968 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014969
14970 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14971 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14972 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14973 of ms on remote networks.
14974
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014975 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14976 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14977 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014978
14979 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14980 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14981 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14982 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14983 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14984 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14985 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14986 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14987 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14988 to the server until another one is released.
14989
14990Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14991
14992 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14993 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14994 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14995
14996 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14997 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14998 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14999
15000 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
15001 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15002 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15003 flags.
15004
15005 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15006 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
15007 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15008 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15009 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15010 the client connection was maintained open.
15011
15012 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015013 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015014 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
15015 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15016
15017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150188.5. Session state at disconnection
15019-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015020
15021TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15022"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
150232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15024each of which has a special meaning :
15025
15026 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15027 session to terminate :
15028
15029 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15030
15031 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15032 server explicitly refused it.
15033
15034 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15035 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15036 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15037 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015038 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15039
15040 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15041 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015042
15043 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15044 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15045 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15046 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15047 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15048
15049 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15050 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15051 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15052 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15053 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15054
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015055 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15056 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15057
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015058 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15059 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15060 backup connections when going up.
15061
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015062 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15063
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015064 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15065 send or receive data.
15066
15067 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15068 send or receive data.
15069
15070 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15071 with nothing left in the buffers.
15072
15073 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015075 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015076 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15077
15078 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15079 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15080 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15081 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15082 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15083
15084 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15085 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15086
15087 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15088 server (HTTP only).
15089
15090 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15091
15092 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15093 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15094 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15095
15096 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15097 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15098 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15099
15100 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15101
15102 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15103 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15104
15105 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15106 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15107 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15108
15109 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15110 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015111 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15112 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015113
15114 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15115 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15116 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15117 another server.
15118
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015119 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015120 server.
15121
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015122 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15123 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15124 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15125 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15126
15127 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15128 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15129 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15130 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15131
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015132 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15133 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15134 "use-server" rule).
15135
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015136 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15137
15138 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15139 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15140
15141 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15142
15143 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15144 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15145 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15146
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015147 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15148 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015149 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015150 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15151 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15152
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015153 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15154
15155 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15156 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15157
15158 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15159
15160 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15161
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015162The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15163was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015164helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15165starvation, attacks, etc...
15166
15167The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15168alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15169easier finding and understanding.
15170
15171 Flags Reason
15172
15173 -- Normal termination.
15174
15175 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15176 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15177 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15178 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15179
15180 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15181 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15182 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15183 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15184 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15185 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015187 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15188 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015189 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015190
15191 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15192 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15193 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15194
15195 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15196 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15197 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15198 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15199 the server takes too long to respond.
15200
15201 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15202 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15203 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15204 long a time to respond.
15205
15206 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15207 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15208 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15209 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015210 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15211 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015212
15213 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15214 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15215 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15216 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15217 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015218 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015219 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15220 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15221 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15222 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15223 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15224 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15225 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15226 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15227 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15228 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15229 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15230 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015231
15232 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15233 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015234 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15235 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15236 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15237 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015238
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015239 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15240 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015242 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015243 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15244 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15245 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15246 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15247 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15248
15249 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15250 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15251 503 or 504 here.
15252
15253 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15254 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15255 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15256 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15257 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15258
15259 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15260 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015261 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015262 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15263 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15264
15265 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15266 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15267 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15268 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15269 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15270 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15271 between haproxy and the server.
15272
15273 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15274 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15275 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15276 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15277 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15278 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15279 solution is to fix the application.
15280
15281 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15282 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15283 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15284 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15285 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15286 external attacks.
15287
15288 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15289 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015290 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015291 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15292 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15293
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015294 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15295 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15296 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015297 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15298 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015300 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15301 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15302 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15303 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015304 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15305 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15306 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15307 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15308 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015309
15310 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15311 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15312 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15313 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15314
15315 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15316 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15317 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15318 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15319
15320 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15321 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15322 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15323 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15324
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015325The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15326persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15327important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15328re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15329
15330 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15331
15332 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15333 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15334 set on a GET request.
15335
15336 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15337 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015338 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015339 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15340
15341 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15342 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15343 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15344
15345 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15346 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15347 already got a cookie.
15348
15349 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15350 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15351 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15352 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15353 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15354
15355 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15356 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15357 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15358
15359 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15360 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15361 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15362
15363 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15364 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15365
15366 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15367 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15368 then advertised in the response.
15369
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153718.6. Non-printable characters
15372-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015373
15374In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15375consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15376converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15377prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15378being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15379escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15380is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15381'}' when logging headers.
15382
15383Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15384issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15385containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15386
15387Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15388the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15389performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15390
15391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15393---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015394
15395Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15396achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015397section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015398cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15399the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15400the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015401locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015402not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15403user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15404a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15405wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15406
15407 Examples :
15408 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15409 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15410
15411 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15412 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15413
15414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15416---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015417
15418Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15419proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15420the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15421server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15422
15423Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15424response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015425section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015426
15427It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015428time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15429appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015430are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15431and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15432follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15433request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15434in the logs.
15435
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015436As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15437frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15438an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15439
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015440 Example :
15441 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15442 listen proxy-out
15443 mode http
15444 option httplog
15445 option logasap
15446 log global
15447 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15448
15449 # log the name of the virtual server
15450 capture request header Host len 20
15451
15452 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15453 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15454
15455 # log the beginning of the referrer
15456 capture request header Referer len 20
15457
15458 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15459 capture response header Server len 20
15460
15461 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15462 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15463
15464 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15465 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15466
15467 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15468 capture response header Via len 20
15469
15470 # log the URL location during a redirection
15471 capture response header Location len 20
15472
15473 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15474 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15475 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15476 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15477 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15478
15479 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15480 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15481 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15482 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015483 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015484
15485 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15486 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15487 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15488 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15489 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015490 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015491
15492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154938.9. Examples of logs
15494---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015495
15496These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15497them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15498reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15499
15500 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15501 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15502 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15503
15504 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15505 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15506
15507 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15508 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15509 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15510
15511 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15512 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15513
15514 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15515 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15516 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15517
15518 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015519 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015520 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15521 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15522
15523 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15524 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15525 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15526
15527 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15528 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015529 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015530 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15531 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15532 to return the 502 and not the server.
15533
15534 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015535 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015536
15537 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15538 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15539 Nothing was sent to any server.
15540
15541 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15542 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15543
15544 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15545 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15546 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15547 send a 408 return code to the client.
15548
15549 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15550 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15551
15552 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15553 5 seconds ("c----").
15554
15555 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15556 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015557 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015558
15559 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015560 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015561 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15562 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15563 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15564 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15565 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015566
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015567
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200155689. Supported filters
15569--------------------
15570
15571Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15572accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15573unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15574
15575See also : "filter"
15576
155779.1. Trace
15578----------
15579
15580filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15581
15582 Arguments:
15583 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15584 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15585
15586 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15587 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15588 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15589 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15590
15591 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15592 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15593 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15594 amount of the parsed data.
15595
15596This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15597callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15598information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15599filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15600
15601Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15602tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15603a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15604
15605
156069.2. HTTP compression
15607---------------------
15608
15609filter compression
15610
15611The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15612keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15613when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15614use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15615used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15616filters evaluation order.
15617
15618See also : "compression"
15619
15620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015621/*
15622 * Local variables:
15623 * fill-column: 79
15624 * End:
15625 */